You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

17816 lines
475KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program.
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  173. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  174. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  175. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  176. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  177. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  178. @end example
  179. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  180. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  181. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  182. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  183. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  184. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  185. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  186. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  187. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  188. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  189. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  190. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  191. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  192. characters contained within it.
  193. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  194. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  195. @example
  196. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  197. @end example
  198. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  199. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  200. @example
  201. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  202. @end example
  203. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  204. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  205. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  206. @example
  207. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  208. @end example
  209. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  210. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  211. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  212. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  213. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  214. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  215. previous string will finally result in:
  216. @example
  217. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  218. @end example
  219. @chapter Timeline editing
  220. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  221. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  222. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  223. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  224. next filter in the filtergraph.
  225. The expression accepts the following values:
  226. @table @samp
  227. @item t
  228. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  229. @item n
  230. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  231. @item pos
  232. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  233. @item w
  234. @item h
  235. width and height of the input frame if video
  236. @end table
  237. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  238. to re-define the expression.
  239. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  240. rules.
  241. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  242. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  243. @example
  244. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  245. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  246. @end example
  247. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  248. @chapter Audio Filters
  249. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  250. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  251. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  252. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  253. build.
  254. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  255. @section acompressor
  256. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  257. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  258. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  259. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  260. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  261. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  262. but can also destroy a track completely).
  263. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  264. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  265. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  266. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  267. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  268. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  269. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  270. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  271. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  272. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  273. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  274. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  275. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  276. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  277. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  278. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  279. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  280. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  281. The filter accepts the following options:
  282. @table @option
  283. @item level_in
  284. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  285. @item threshold
  286. If a signal of second stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  287. reduction of the first stream.
  288. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  289. @item ratio
  290. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  291. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  292. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  293. @item attack
  294. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  295. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  296. @item release
  297. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  298. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  299. @item makeup
  300. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  301. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  302. @item knee
  303. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  304. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  305. @item link
  306. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  307. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  308. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  309. @item detection
  310. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  311. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  312. @item mix
  313. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  314. Range is between 0 and 1.
  315. @end table
  316. @section acrossfade
  317. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  318. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  319. The filter accepts the following options:
  320. @table @option
  321. @item nb_samples, ns
  322. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  323. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  324. silent. Default is 44100.
  325. @item duration, d
  326. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  327. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  328. for the accepted syntax.
  329. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  330. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  331. @item overlap, o
  332. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  333. @item curve1
  334. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  335. @item curve2
  336. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  337. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  338. @end table
  339. @subsection Examples
  340. @itemize
  341. @item
  342. Cross fade from one input to another:
  343. @example
  344. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  345. @end example
  346. @item
  347. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  348. @example
  349. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  350. @end example
  351. @end itemize
  352. @section acrusher
  353. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  354. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  355. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  356. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  357. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  358. This filter is able to even round to continous values instead of discrete
  359. bit depths.
  360. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  361. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  362. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  363. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  364. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  365. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  366. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception, too
  367. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  368. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  369. The filter accepts the following options:
  370. @table @option
  371. @item level_in
  372. Set level in.
  373. @item level_out
  374. Set level out.
  375. @item bits
  376. Set bit reduction.
  377. @item mix
  378. Set mixing ammount.
  379. @item mode
  380. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  381. @item dc
  382. Set DC.
  383. @item aa
  384. Set anti-aliasing.
  385. @item samples
  386. Set sample reduction.
  387. @item lfo
  388. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  389. @item lforange
  390. Set LFO range.
  391. @item lforate
  392. Set LFO rate.
  393. @end table
  394. @section adelay
  395. Delay one or more audio channels.
  396. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  397. The filter accepts the following option:
  398. @table @option
  399. @item delays
  400. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  401. At least one delay greater than 0 should be provided.
  402. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  403. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  404. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  405. @end table
  406. @subsection Examples
  407. @itemize
  408. @item
  409. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  410. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  411. @example
  412. adelay=1500|0|500
  413. @end example
  414. @item
  415. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  416. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  417. @example
  418. adelay=0|500S|700S
  419. @end example
  420. @end itemize
  421. @section aecho
  422. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  423. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  424. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  425. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  426. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  427. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  428. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  429. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  430. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  431. @table @option
  432. @item in_gain
  433. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  434. @item out_gain
  435. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  436. @item delays
  437. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  438. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  439. Default is @code{1000}.
  440. @item decays
  441. Set list of loudnesses of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  442. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  443. Default is @code{0.5}.
  444. @end table
  445. @subsection Examples
  446. @itemize
  447. @item
  448. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  449. @example
  450. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  451. @end example
  452. @item
  453. If delay is very short, then it sound like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  454. @example
  455. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  456. @end example
  457. @item
  458. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  459. @example
  460. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  461. @end example
  462. @item
  463. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  464. @example
  465. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  466. @end example
  467. @end itemize
  468. @section aemphasis
  469. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  470. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  471. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  472. this recording medium.
  473. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  474. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  475. The filter accepts the following options:
  476. @table @option
  477. @item level_in
  478. Set input gain.
  479. @item level_out
  480. Set output gain.
  481. @item mode
  482. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  483. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  484. @item type
  485. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  486. @table @option
  487. @item col
  488. select Columbia.
  489. @item emi
  490. select EMI.
  491. @item bsi
  492. select BSI (78RPM).
  493. @item riaa
  494. select RIAA.
  495. @item cd
  496. select Compact Disc (CD).
  497. @item 50fm
  498. select 50µs (FM).
  499. @item 75fm
  500. select 75µs (FM).
  501. @item 50kf
  502. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  503. @item 75kf
  504. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  505. @end table
  506. @end table
  507. @section aeval
  508. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  509. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  510. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  511. It accepts the following parameters:
  512. @table @option
  513. @item exprs
  514. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  515. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  516. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  517. output channels.
  518. @item channel_layout, c
  519. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  520. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  521. use by default the same input channel layout.
  522. @end table
  523. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  524. @table @option
  525. @item ch
  526. channel number of the current expression
  527. @item n
  528. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  529. @item s
  530. sample rate
  531. @item t
  532. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  533. @item nb_in_channels
  534. @item nb_out_channels
  535. input and output number of channels
  536. @item val(CH)
  537. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  538. @end table
  539. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  540. dedicated filter.
  541. @subsection Examples
  542. @itemize
  543. @item
  544. Half volume:
  545. @example
  546. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  547. @end example
  548. @item
  549. Invert phase of the second channel:
  550. @example
  551. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  552. @end example
  553. @end itemize
  554. @anchor{afade}
  555. @section afade
  556. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  557. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  558. @table @option
  559. @item type, t
  560. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  561. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  562. @item start_sample, ss
  563. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  564. effect. Default is 0.
  565. @item nb_samples, ns
  566. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  567. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  568. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  569. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  570. @item start_time, st
  571. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  572. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  573. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  574. for the accepted syntax.
  575. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  576. @item duration, d
  577. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  578. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  579. for the accepted syntax.
  580. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  581. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  582. the output audio will be silence.
  583. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  584. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  585. @item curve
  586. Set curve for fade transition.
  587. It accepts the following values:
  588. @table @option
  589. @item tri
  590. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  591. @item qsin
  592. select quarter of sine wave
  593. @item hsin
  594. select half of sine wave
  595. @item esin
  596. select exponential sine wave
  597. @item log
  598. select logarithmic
  599. @item ipar
  600. select inverted parabola
  601. @item qua
  602. select quadratic
  603. @item cub
  604. select cubic
  605. @item squ
  606. select square root
  607. @item cbr
  608. select cubic root
  609. @item par
  610. select parabola
  611. @item exp
  612. select exponential
  613. @item iqsin
  614. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  615. @item ihsin
  616. select inverted half of sine wave
  617. @item dese
  618. select double-exponential seat
  619. @item desi
  620. select double-exponential sigmoid
  621. @end table
  622. @end table
  623. @subsection Examples
  624. @itemize
  625. @item
  626. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  627. @example
  628. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  629. @end example
  630. @item
  631. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  632. @example
  633. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  634. @end example
  635. @end itemize
  636. @section afftfilt
  637. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  638. @table @option
  639. @item real
  640. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  641. by '|'. Default is "1".
  642. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  643. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  644. output channels.
  645. @item imag
  646. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  647. separated by '|'. If not set, @var{real} option is used.
  648. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  649. constants:
  650. @table @option
  651. @item sr
  652. sample rate
  653. @item b
  654. current frequency bin number
  655. @item nb
  656. number of available bins
  657. @item ch
  658. channel number of the current expression
  659. @item chs
  660. number of channels
  661. @item pts
  662. current frame pts
  663. @end table
  664. @item win_size
  665. Set window size.
  666. It accepts the following values:
  667. @table @samp
  668. @item w16
  669. @item w32
  670. @item w64
  671. @item w128
  672. @item w256
  673. @item w512
  674. @item w1024
  675. @item w2048
  676. @item w4096
  677. @item w8192
  678. @item w16384
  679. @item w32768
  680. @item w65536
  681. @end table
  682. Default is @code{w4096}
  683. @item win_func
  684. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  685. @item overlap
  686. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  687. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  688. @end table
  689. @subsection Examples
  690. @itemize
  691. @item
  692. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  693. @example
  694. afftfilt="1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1)"
  695. @end example
  696. @end itemize
  697. @anchor{aformat}
  698. @section aformat
  699. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  700. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  701. It accepts the following parameters:
  702. @table @option
  703. @item sample_fmts
  704. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  705. @item sample_rates
  706. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  707. @item channel_layouts
  708. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  709. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  710. for the required syntax.
  711. @end table
  712. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  713. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  714. @example
  715. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  716. @end example
  717. @section agate
  718. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  719. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  720. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  721. and divide it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  722. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  723. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  724. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  725. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  726. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  727. has to raise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  728. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  729. @table @option
  730. @item level_in
  731. Set input level before filtering.
  732. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  733. @item range
  734. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  735. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  736. @item threshold
  737. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  738. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  739. @item ratio
  740. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  741. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  742. @item attack
  743. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  744. reduction stops.
  745. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  746. @item release
  747. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  748. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  749. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  750. @item makeup
  751. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  752. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  753. @item knee
  754. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  755. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  756. @item detection
  757. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  758. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  759. @item link
  760. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  761. the reduction.
  762. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  763. @end table
  764. @section alimiter
  765. The limiter prevents input signal from raising over a desired threshold.
  766. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  767. It means that there is a small delay after signal is processed. Keep in mind
  768. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  769. The filter accepts the following options:
  770. @table @option
  771. @item level_in
  772. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  773. @item level_out
  774. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  775. @item limit
  776. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  777. @item attack
  778. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  779. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  780. @item release
  781. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  782. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  783. @item asc
  784. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  785. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  786. time.
  787. @item asc_level
  788. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  789. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  790. @item level
  791. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  792. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  793. @end table
  794. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  795. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  796. @section allpass
  797. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  798. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  799. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  800. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  801. The filter accepts the following options:
  802. @table @option
  803. @item frequency, f
  804. Set frequency in Hz.
  805. @item width_type
  806. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  807. @table @option
  808. @item h
  809. Hz
  810. @item q
  811. Q-Factor
  812. @item o
  813. octave
  814. @item s
  815. slope
  816. @end table
  817. @item width, w
  818. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  819. @end table
  820. @section aloop
  821. Loop audio samples.
  822. The filter accepts the following options:
  823. @table @option
  824. @item loop
  825. Set the number of loops.
  826. @item size
  827. Set maximal number of samples.
  828. @item start
  829. Set first sample of loop.
  830. @end table
  831. @anchor{amerge}
  832. @section amerge
  833. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  834. The filter accepts the following options:
  835. @table @option
  836. @item inputs
  837. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  838. @end table
  839. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  840. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  841. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  842. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  843. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  844. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  845. channels.
  846. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  847. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  848. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  849. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  850. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  851. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  852. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  853. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  854. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  855. shortest.
  856. @subsection Examples
  857. @itemize
  858. @item
  859. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  860. @example
  861. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  862. @end example
  863. @item
  864. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  865. @example
  866. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  867. @end example
  868. @end itemize
  869. @section amix
  870. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  871. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  872. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  873. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  874. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  875. For example
  876. @example
  877. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  878. @end example
  879. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  880. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  881. It accepts the following parameters:
  882. @table @option
  883. @item inputs
  884. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  885. @item duration
  886. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  887. @table @option
  888. @item longest
  889. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  890. @item shortest
  891. The duration of the shortest input.
  892. @item first
  893. The duration of the first input.
  894. @end table
  895. @item dropout_transition
  896. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  897. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  898. @end table
  899. @section anequalizer
  900. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  901. It accepts the following parameters:
  902. @table @option
  903. @item params
  904. This option string is in format:
  905. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  906. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  907. @table @option
  908. @item chn
  909. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  910. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  911. @item f
  912. Set central frequency for band.
  913. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  914. @item w
  915. Set band width in hertz.
  916. @item g
  917. Set band gain in dB.
  918. @item t
  919. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  920. @table @samp
  921. @item 0
  922. Butterworth, this is default.
  923. @item 1
  924. Chebyshev type 1.
  925. @item 2
  926. Chebyshev type 2.
  927. @end table
  928. @end table
  929. @item curves
  930. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  931. in video stream.
  932. @item size
  933. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  934. @item mgain
  935. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  936. Setting this to reasonable value allows to display gain which is derived from
  937. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  938. when both are activated.
  939. @item fscale
  940. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  941. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  942. @item colors
  943. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  944. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  945. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  946. @end table
  947. @subsection Examples
  948. @itemize
  949. @item
  950. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  951. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  952. @example
  953. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  954. @end example
  955. @end itemize
  956. @subsection Commands
  957. This filter supports the following commands:
  958. @table @option
  959. @item change
  960. Alter existing filter parameters.
  961. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  962. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  963. error is returned.
  964. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  965. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  966. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  967. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  968. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  969. @end table
  970. @section anull
  971. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  972. @section apad
  973. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  974. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  975. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  976. A description of the accepted options follows.
  977. @table @option
  978. @item packet_size
  979. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  980. @item pad_len
  981. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  982. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  983. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  984. @item whole_len
  985. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  986. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  987. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  988. with @option{pad_len}.
  989. @end table
  990. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} option is
  991. set, the filter will add silence to the end of the input stream
  992. indefinitely.
  993. @subsection Examples
  994. @itemize
  995. @item
  996. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  997. @example
  998. apad=pad_len=1024
  999. @end example
  1000. @item
  1001. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1002. the input with silence if required:
  1003. @example
  1004. apad=whole_len=10000
  1005. @end example
  1006. @item
  1007. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1008. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1009. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1010. option:
  1011. @example
  1012. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1013. @end example
  1014. @end itemize
  1015. @section aphaser
  1016. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1017. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1018. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1019. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1020. @table @option
  1021. @item in_gain
  1022. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1023. @item out_gain
  1024. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1025. @item delay
  1026. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1027. @item decay
  1028. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1029. @item speed
  1030. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1031. @item type
  1032. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1033. It accepts the following values:
  1034. @table @samp
  1035. @item triangular, t
  1036. @item sinusoidal, s
  1037. @end table
  1038. @end table
  1039. @section apulsator
  1040. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1041. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1042. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1043. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1044. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1045. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1046. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1047. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1048. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1049. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1050. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1051. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1052. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1053. The filter accepts the following options:
  1054. @table @option
  1055. @item level_in
  1056. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1057. @item level_out
  1058. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1059. @item mode
  1060. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1061. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1062. @item amount
  1063. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1064. @item offset_l
  1065. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1066. @item offset_r
  1067. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1068. @item width
  1069. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1070. @item timing
  1071. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1072. @item bpm
  1073. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1074. is set to bpm.
  1075. @item ms
  1076. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1077. is set to ms.
  1078. @item hz
  1079. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1080. if timing is set to hz.
  1081. @end table
  1082. @anchor{aresample}
  1083. @section aresample
  1084. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1085. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1086. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1087. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1088. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1089. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1090. The filter accepts the syntax
  1091. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1092. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1093. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1094. ffmpeg-resampler manual for the complete list of supported options.
  1095. @subsection Examples
  1096. @itemize
  1097. @item
  1098. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1099. @example
  1100. aresample=44100
  1101. @end example
  1102. @item
  1103. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1104. samples per second compensation:
  1105. @example
  1106. aresample=async=1000
  1107. @end example
  1108. @end itemize
  1109. @section areverse
  1110. Reverse an audio clip.
  1111. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1112. is suggested.
  1113. @subsection Examples
  1114. @itemize
  1115. @item
  1116. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1117. @example
  1118. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1119. @end example
  1120. @end itemize
  1121. @section asetnsamples
  1122. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1123. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1124. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1125. signal its end.
  1126. The filter accepts the following options:
  1127. @table @option
  1128. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1129. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1130. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1131. Default value is 1024.
  1132. @item pad, p
  1133. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1134. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1135. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1136. @end table
  1137. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1138. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1139. @example
  1140. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1141. @end example
  1142. @section asetrate
  1143. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1144. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1145. The filter accepts the following options:
  1146. @table @option
  1147. @item sample_rate, r
  1148. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1149. @end table
  1150. @section ashowinfo
  1151. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1152. The input audio is not modified.
  1153. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1154. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1155. The following values are shown in the output:
  1156. @table @option
  1157. @item n
  1158. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1159. @item pts
  1160. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1161. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1162. @item pts_time
  1163. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1164. @item pos
  1165. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1166. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1167. @item fmt
  1168. The sample format.
  1169. @item chlayout
  1170. The channel layout.
  1171. @item rate
  1172. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1173. @item nb_samples
  1174. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1175. @item checksum
  1176. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1177. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1178. @item plane_checksums
  1179. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1180. @end table
  1181. @anchor{astats}
  1182. @section astats
  1183. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1184. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1185. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1186. It accepts the following option:
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item length
  1189. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1190. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 10]}.
  1191. @item metadata
  1192. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1193. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1194. disabled.
  1195. Available keys for each channel are:
  1196. DC_offset
  1197. Min_level
  1198. Max_level
  1199. Min_difference
  1200. Max_difference
  1201. Mean_difference
  1202. Peak_level
  1203. RMS_peak
  1204. RMS_trough
  1205. Crest_factor
  1206. Flat_factor
  1207. Peak_count
  1208. Bit_depth
  1209. and for Overall:
  1210. DC_offset
  1211. Min_level
  1212. Max_level
  1213. Min_difference
  1214. Max_difference
  1215. Mean_difference
  1216. Peak_level
  1217. RMS_level
  1218. RMS_peak
  1219. RMS_trough
  1220. Flat_factor
  1221. Peak_count
  1222. Bit_depth
  1223. Number_of_samples
  1224. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1225. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1226. For description what each key means read below.
  1227. @item reset
  1228. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1229. Default is disabled.
  1230. @end table
  1231. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1232. @table @option
  1233. @item DC offset
  1234. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1235. @item Min level
  1236. Minimal sample level.
  1237. @item Max level
  1238. Maximal sample level.
  1239. @item Min difference
  1240. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1241. @item Max difference
  1242. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1243. @item Mean difference
  1244. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1245. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1246. @item Peak level dB
  1247. @item RMS level dB
  1248. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1249. @item RMS peak dB
  1250. @item RMS trough dB
  1251. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1252. @item Crest factor
  1253. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1254. @item Flat factor
  1255. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1256. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1257. @item Peak count
  1258. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1259. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1260. @item Bit depth
  1261. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1262. @end table
  1263. @section asyncts
  1264. Synchronize audio data with timestamps by squeezing/stretching it and/or
  1265. dropping samples/adding silence when needed.
  1266. This filter is not built by default, please use @ref{aresample} to do squeezing/stretching.
  1267. It accepts the following parameters:
  1268. @table @option
  1269. @item compensate
  1270. Enable stretching/squeezing the data to make it match the timestamps. Disabled
  1271. by default. When disabled, time gaps are covered with silence.
  1272. @item min_delta
  1273. The minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
  1274. adding/dropping samples. The default value is 0.1. If you get an imperfect
  1275. sync with this filter, try setting this parameter to 0.
  1276. @item max_comp
  1277. The maximum compensation in samples per second. Only relevant with compensate=1.
  1278. The default value is 500.
  1279. @item first_pts
  1280. Assume that the first PTS should be this value. The time base is 1 / sample
  1281. rate. This allows for padding/trimming at the start of the stream. By default,
  1282. no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or
  1283. trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
  1284. silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
  1285. with a negative PTS due to encoder delay.
  1286. @end table
  1287. @section atempo
  1288. Adjust audio tempo.
  1289. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1290. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1291. be in the [0.5, 2.0] range.
  1292. @subsection Examples
  1293. @itemize
  1294. @item
  1295. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1296. @example
  1297. atempo=0.8
  1298. @end example
  1299. @item
  1300. To speed up audio to 125% tempo:
  1301. @example
  1302. atempo=1.25
  1303. @end example
  1304. @end itemize
  1305. @section atrim
  1306. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1307. It accepts the following parameters:
  1308. @table @option
  1309. @item start
  1310. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1311. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1312. @item end
  1313. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1314. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1315. the last sample in the output.
  1316. @item start_pts
  1317. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1318. instead of seconds.
  1319. @item end_pts
  1320. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1321. of seconds.
  1322. @item duration
  1323. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1324. @item start_sample
  1325. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1326. @item end_sample
  1327. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1328. @end table
  1329. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1330. duration specifications; see
  1331. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1332. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1333. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1334. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1335. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1336. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1337. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1338. atrim filter.
  1339. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1340. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1341. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1342. filters.
  1343. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1344. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1345. Examples:
  1346. @itemize
  1347. @item
  1348. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1349. @example
  1350. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1351. @end example
  1352. @item
  1353. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1354. @example
  1355. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1356. @end example
  1357. @end itemize
  1358. @section bandpass
  1359. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1360. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1361. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1362. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1363. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1364. The filter accepts the following options:
  1365. @table @option
  1366. @item frequency, f
  1367. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1368. @item csg
  1369. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1370. @item width_type
  1371. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1372. @table @option
  1373. @item h
  1374. Hz
  1375. @item q
  1376. Q-Factor
  1377. @item o
  1378. octave
  1379. @item s
  1380. slope
  1381. @end table
  1382. @item width, w
  1383. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1384. @end table
  1385. @section bandreject
  1386. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1387. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1388. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1389. The filter accepts the following options:
  1390. @table @option
  1391. @item frequency, f
  1392. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1393. @item width_type
  1394. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1395. @table @option
  1396. @item h
  1397. Hz
  1398. @item q
  1399. Q-Factor
  1400. @item o
  1401. octave
  1402. @item s
  1403. slope
  1404. @end table
  1405. @item width, w
  1406. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1407. @end table
  1408. @section bass
  1409. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  1410. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  1411. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  1412. The filter accepts the following options:
  1413. @table @option
  1414. @item gain, g
  1415. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  1416. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  1417. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1418. @item frequency, f
  1419. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  1420. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  1421. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  1422. @item width_type
  1423. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1424. @table @option
  1425. @item h
  1426. Hz
  1427. @item q
  1428. Q-Factor
  1429. @item o
  1430. octave
  1431. @item s
  1432. slope
  1433. @end table
  1434. @item width, w
  1435. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  1436. @end table
  1437. @section biquad
  1438. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  1439. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  1440. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  1441. @section bs2b
  1442. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  1443. stereo audio records.
  1444. It accepts the following parameters:
  1445. @table @option
  1446. @item profile
  1447. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  1448. @table @option
  1449. @item default
  1450. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  1451. @item cmoy
  1452. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  1453. @item jmeier
  1454. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  1455. @end table
  1456. @item fcut
  1457. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  1458. @item feed
  1459. Feed level (in Hz).
  1460. @end table
  1461. @section channelmap
  1462. Remap input channels to new locations.
  1463. It accepts the following parameters:
  1464. @table @option
  1465. @item channel_layout
  1466. The channel layout of the output stream.
  1467. @item map
  1468. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  1469. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  1470. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  1471. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  1472. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  1473. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  1474. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  1475. @end table
  1476. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  1477. output channels, preserving indices.
  1478. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  1479. @example
  1480. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  1481. @end example
  1482. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  1483. the input.
  1484. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  1485. @example
  1486. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  1487. @end example
  1488. @section channelsplit
  1489. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  1490. It accepts the following parameters:
  1491. @table @option
  1492. @item channel_layout
  1493. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  1494. @end table
  1495. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  1496. @example
  1497. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  1498. @end example
  1499. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  1500. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  1501. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  1502. @example
  1503. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  1504. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  1505. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  1506. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  1507. side_right.wav
  1508. @end example
  1509. @section chorus
  1510. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  1511. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  1512. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  1513. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  1514. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  1515. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  1516. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  1517. off key.
  1518. It accepts the following parameters:
  1519. @table @option
  1520. @item in_gain
  1521. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1522. @item out_gain
  1523. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  1524. @item delays
  1525. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  1526. @item decays
  1527. Set decays.
  1528. @item speeds
  1529. Set speeds.
  1530. @item depths
  1531. Set depths.
  1532. @end table
  1533. @subsection Examples
  1534. @itemize
  1535. @item
  1536. A single delay:
  1537. @example
  1538. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  1539. @end example
  1540. @item
  1541. Two delays:
  1542. @example
  1543. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  1544. @end example
  1545. @item
  1546. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  1547. @example
  1548. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  1549. @end example
  1550. @end itemize
  1551. @section compand
  1552. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  1553. It accepts the following parameters:
  1554. @table @option
  1555. @item attacks
  1556. @item decays
  1557. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  1558. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  1559. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  1560. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  1561. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  1562. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  1563. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  1564. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  1565. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  1566. @item points
  1567. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  1568. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  1569. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  1570. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  1571. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  1572. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  1573. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  1574. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20}.
  1575. @item soft-knee
  1576. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  1577. @item gain
  1578. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  1579. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  1580. It defaults to 0.
  1581. @item volume
  1582. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  1583. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  1584. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  1585. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  1586. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  1587. @item delay
  1588. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  1589. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  1590. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  1591. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  1592. @end table
  1593. @subsection Examples
  1594. @itemize
  1595. @item
  1596. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  1597. noisy environment:
  1598. @example
  1599. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  1600. @end example
  1601. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  1602. @example
  1603. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  1604. @end example
  1605. @item
  1606. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  1607. @example
  1608. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  1612. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  1613. @example
  1614. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  1615. @end example
  1616. @item
  1617. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  1618. @example
  1619. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  1620. @end example
  1621. @item
  1622. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  1623. @example
  1624. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  1625. @end example
  1626. @item
  1627. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  1628. @example
  1629. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  1630. @end example
  1631. @item
  1632. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  1633. @example
  1634. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  1635. @end example
  1636. @item
  1637. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  1638. @example
  1639. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  1640. @end example
  1641. @item
  1642. Compressor/Gate:
  1643. @example
  1644. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  1645. @end example
  1646. @item
  1647. Expander:
  1648. @example
  1649. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  1650. @end example
  1651. @item
  1652. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  1653. @example
  1654. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  1655. @end example
  1656. @item
  1657. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  1658. @example
  1659. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  1660. @end example
  1661. @item
  1662. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  1663. @example
  1664. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  1665. @end example
  1666. @item
  1667. Soft limiter:
  1668. @example
  1669. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  1670. @end example
  1671. @end itemize
  1672. @section compensationdelay
  1673. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  1674. positions of microphones or speakers.
  1675. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  1676. different location. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  1677. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  1678. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  1679. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that distance of
  1680. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone to capture signal in
  1681. antiphase to another microphone. That makes the final mix sounding moody.
  1682. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  1683. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  1684. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  1685. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  1686. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  1687. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  1688. It accepts the following parameters:
  1689. @table @option
  1690. @item mm
  1691. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  1692. Default is 0.
  1693. @item cm
  1694. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  1695. Default is 0.
  1696. @item m
  1697. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  1698. Default is 0.
  1699. @item dry
  1700. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  1701. Default is 0.
  1702. @item wet
  1703. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  1704. Default is 1.
  1705. @item temp
  1706. Set temperature degree in Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  1707. Default is 20.
  1708. @end table
  1709. @section crystalizer
  1710. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  1711. The filter accepts the following options:
  1712. @table @option
  1713. @item i
  1714. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  1715. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  1716. @item c
  1717. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  1718. @end table
  1719. @section dcshift
  1720. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  1721. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  1722. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  1723. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  1724. a signal has a DC offset.
  1725. @table @option
  1726. @item shift
  1727. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  1728. the audio.
  1729. @item limitergain
  1730. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  1731. used to prevent clipping.
  1732. @end table
  1733. @section dynaudnorm
  1734. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  1735. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  1736. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  1737. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  1738. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  1739. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  1740. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  1741. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  1742. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  1743. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  1744. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  1745. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  1746. @table @option
  1747. @item f
  1748. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  1749. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  1750. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  1751. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  1752. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  1753. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  1754. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  1755. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  1756. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  1757. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  1758. been found to give good results with most files.
  1759. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  1760. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  1761. @item g
  1762. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  1763. number. Default is 31.
  1764. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  1765. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  1766. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  1767. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  1768. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  1769. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  1770. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  1771. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  1772. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  1773. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1774. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  1775. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1776. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  1777. @item p
  1778. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  1779. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  1780. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  1781. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  1782. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  1783. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  1784. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  1785. @item m
  1786. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  1787. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  1788. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  1789. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  1790. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  1791. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  1792. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  1793. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  1794. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  1795. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  1796. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  1797. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  1798. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  1799. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  1800. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  1801. value.
  1802. @item r
  1803. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  1804. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  1805. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  1806. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  1807. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  1808. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  1809. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  1810. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  1811. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  1812. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  1813. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  1814. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  1815. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  1816. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  1817. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  1818. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  1819. @item n
  1820. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  1821. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  1822. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  1823. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  1824. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  1825. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  1826. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  1827. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  1828. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  1829. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  1830. @item c
  1831. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  1832. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  1833. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  1834. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  1835. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  1836. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  1837. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  1838. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  1839. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  1840. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  1841. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  1842. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  1843. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  1844. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  1845. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  1846. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  1847. between neighbouring frames.
  1848. @item b
  1849. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  1850. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  1851. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  1852. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  1853. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  1854. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  1855. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  1856. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  1857. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  1858. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  1859. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  1860. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  1861. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  1862. @item s
  1863. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  1864. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  1865. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  1866. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  1867. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  1868. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  1869. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  1870. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  1871. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  1872. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  1873. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  1874. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  1875. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  1876. frame.
  1877. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  1878. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  1879. @end table
  1880. @section earwax
  1881. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  1882. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  1883. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  1884. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  1885. the listener (standard for speakers).
  1886. Ported from SoX.
  1887. @section equalizer
  1888. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  1889. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  1890. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  1891. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  1892. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  1893. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  1894. The filter accepts the following options:
  1895. @table @option
  1896. @item frequency, f
  1897. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  1898. @item width_type
  1899. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1900. @table @option
  1901. @item h
  1902. Hz
  1903. @item q
  1904. Q-Factor
  1905. @item o
  1906. octave
  1907. @item s
  1908. slope
  1909. @end table
  1910. @item width, w
  1911. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1912. @item gain, g
  1913. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  1914. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1915. @end table
  1916. @subsection Examples
  1917. @itemize
  1918. @item
  1919. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  1920. @example
  1921. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=h:width=200:g=-10
  1922. @end example
  1923. @item
  1924. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  1925. @example
  1926. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=q:width=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:width_type=q:width=2:g=-5
  1927. @end example
  1928. @end itemize
  1929. @section extrastereo
  1930. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  1931. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  1932. The filter accepts the following options:
  1933. @table @option
  1934. @item m
  1935. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  1936. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  1937. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  1938. @item c
  1939. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  1940. @end table
  1941. @section firequalizer
  1942. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  1943. The filter accepts the following option:
  1944. @table @option
  1945. @item gain
  1946. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  1947. @table @option
  1948. @item f
  1949. the evaluated frequency
  1950. @item sr
  1951. sample rate
  1952. @item ch
  1953. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1954. @item chid
  1955. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  1956. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1957. @item chs
  1958. number of channels
  1959. @item chlayout
  1960. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  1961. @end table
  1962. and functions:
  1963. @table @option
  1964. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  1965. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  1966. @end table
  1967. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  1968. @item gain_entry
  1969. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  1970. contain functions:
  1971. @table @option
  1972. @item entry(f, g)
  1973. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  1974. @end table
  1975. This option is also available as command.
  1976. @item delay
  1977. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  1978. Default is @code{0.01}.
  1979. @item accuracy
  1980. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  1981. Default is @code{5}.
  1982. @item wfunc
  1983. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  1984. @table @option
  1985. @item rectangular
  1986. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  1987. @item hann
  1988. hann window (default)
  1989. @item hamming
  1990. hamming window
  1991. @item blackman
  1992. blackman window
  1993. @item nuttall3
  1994. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1995. @item mnuttall3
  1996. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  1997. @item nuttall
  1998. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1999. @item bnuttall
  2000. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2001. @item bharris
  2002. blackman-harris window
  2003. @end table
  2004. @item fixed
  2005. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2006. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2007. @item multi
  2008. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2009. @item zero_phase
  2010. Enable zero phase mode by substracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2011. Default is disabled.
  2012. @end table
  2013. @subsection Examples
  2014. @itemize
  2015. @item
  2016. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2017. @example
  2018. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2019. @end example
  2020. @item
  2021. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2022. @example
  2023. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2024. @end example
  2025. @item
  2026. custom equalization:
  2027. @example
  2028. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2029. @end example
  2030. @item
  2031. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2032. @example
  2033. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2034. @end example
  2035. @item
  2036. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2037. @example
  2038. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2039. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2040. @end example
  2041. @end itemize
  2042. @section flanger
  2043. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2044. The filter accepts the following options:
  2045. @table @option
  2046. @item delay
  2047. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2048. @item depth
  2049. Set added swep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2050. @item regen
  2051. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2052. Default value is 0.
  2053. @item width
  2054. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2055. Default value is 71.
  2056. @item speed
  2057. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2058. @item shape
  2059. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2060. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2061. @item phase
  2062. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2063. Default value is 25.
  2064. @item interp
  2065. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2066. Default is @var{linear}.
  2067. @end table
  2068. @section hdcd
  2069. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2070. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2071. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2072. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2073. @example
  2074. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2075. @end example
  2076. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2077. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2078. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2079. @example
  2080. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2081. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -acodec pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2082. @end example
  2083. The filter accepts the following options:
  2084. @table @option
  2085. @item disable_autoconvert
  2086. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2087. @item process_stereo
  2088. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2089. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2090. @item cdt_ms
  2091. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2092. @item force_pe
  2093. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2094. @item analyze_mode
  2095. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2096. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2097. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2098. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2099. Modes are:
  2100. @table @samp
  2101. @item 0, off
  2102. Disabled
  2103. @item 1, lle
  2104. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  2105. @item 2, pe
  2106. Samples where peak extend occurs
  2107. @item 3, cdt
  2108. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  2109. @item 4, tgm
  2110. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  2111. @end table
  2112. @end table
  2113. @section highpass
  2114. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  2115. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  2116. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  2117. The filter accepts the following options:
  2118. @table @option
  2119. @item frequency, f
  2120. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  2121. @item poles, p
  2122. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  2123. @item width_type
  2124. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2125. @table @option
  2126. @item h
  2127. Hz
  2128. @item q
  2129. Q-Factor
  2130. @item o
  2131. octave
  2132. @item s
  2133. slope
  2134. @end table
  2135. @item width, w
  2136. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2137. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2138. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2139. @end table
  2140. @section join
  2141. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  2142. It accepts the following parameters:
  2143. @table @option
  2144. @item inputs
  2145. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  2146. @item channel_layout
  2147. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  2148. @item map
  2149. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2150. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  2151. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  2152. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  2153. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  2154. channel.
  2155. @end table
  2156. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  2157. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  2158. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  2159. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  2160. @example
  2161. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  2162. @end example
  2163. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  2164. @example
  2165. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  2166. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  2167. out
  2168. @end example
  2169. @section ladspa
  2170. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  2171. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2172. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  2173. @table @option
  2174. @item file, f
  2175. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  2176. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  2177. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  2178. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  2179. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  2180. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  2181. @item plugin, p
  2182. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  2183. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  2184. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  2185. @item controls, c
  2186. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  2187. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  2188. threshold or gain).
  2189. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  2190. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  2191. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2192. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  2193. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  2194. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2195. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  2196. their valid ranges are printed.
  2197. @item sample_rate, s
  2198. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  2199. zero inputs.
  2200. @item nb_samples, n
  2201. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  2202. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2203. @item duration, d
  2204. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  2205. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  2206. for the accepted syntax.
  2207. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  2208. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  2209. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  2210. supposed to be generated forever.
  2211. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2212. @end table
  2213. @subsection Examples
  2214. @itemize
  2215. @item
  2216. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  2217. @example
  2218. ladspa=file=amp
  2219. @end example
  2220. @item
  2221. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  2222. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  2223. @example
  2224. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  2225. @end example
  2226. @item
  2227. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  2228. plugin library:
  2229. @example
  2230. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  2231. @end example
  2232. @item
  2233. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  2234. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  2235. @example
  2236. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  2237. @end example
  2238. @item
  2239. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  2240. @example
  2241. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  2242. @end example
  2243. @item
  2244. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  2245. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  2246. @example
  2247. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  2248. @end example
  2249. @item
  2250. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  2251. @example
  2252. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  2253. @end example
  2254. @item
  2255. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  2256. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2257. @example
  2258. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  2259. @end example
  2260. @item
  2261. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  2262. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2263. @example
  2264. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  2265. @end example
  2266. @end itemize
  2267. @subsection Commands
  2268. This filter supports the following commands:
  2269. @table @option
  2270. @item cN
  2271. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  2272. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  2273. @end table
  2274. @section loudnorm
  2275. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  2276. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  2277. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak.
  2278. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2279. @code{--enable-libebur128}.
  2280. The filter accepts the following options:
  2281. @table @option
  2282. @item I, i
  2283. Set integrated loudness target.
  2284. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  2285. @item LRA, lra
  2286. Set loudness range target.
  2287. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  2288. @item TP, tp
  2289. Set maximum true peak.
  2290. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  2291. @item measured_I, measured_i
  2292. Measured IL of input file.
  2293. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  2294. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  2295. Measured LRA of input file.
  2296. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  2297. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  2298. Measured true peak of input file.
  2299. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  2300. @item measured_thresh
  2301. Measured threshold of input file.
  2302. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  2303. @item offset
  2304. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  2305. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  2306. @item linear
  2307. Normalize linearly if possible.
  2308. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  2309. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  2310. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  2311. @item dual_mono
  2312. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  2313. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  2314. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  2315. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  2316. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  2317. @item print_format
  2318. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  2319. Default value is none.
  2320. @end table
  2321. @section lowpass
  2322. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  2323. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  2324. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  2325. The filter accepts the following options:
  2326. @table @option
  2327. @item frequency, f
  2328. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  2329. @item poles, p
  2330. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  2331. @item width_type
  2332. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2333. @table @option
  2334. @item h
  2335. Hz
  2336. @item q
  2337. Q-Factor
  2338. @item o
  2339. octave
  2340. @item s
  2341. slope
  2342. @end table
  2343. @item width, w
  2344. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2345. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2346. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2347. @end table
  2348. @anchor{pan}
  2349. @section pan
  2350. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  2351. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  2352. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  2353. stream.
  2354. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  2355. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  2356. @table @option
  2357. @item l
  2358. output channel layout or number of channels
  2359. @item outdef
  2360. output channel specification, of the form:
  2361. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[+[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  2362. @item out_name
  2363. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  2364. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  2365. @item gain
  2366. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  2367. @item in_name
  2368. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  2369. named and numbered input channels
  2370. @end table
  2371. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  2372. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  2373. avoiding clipping noise.
  2374. @subsection Mixing examples
  2375. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  2376. factor for the left channel:
  2377. @example
  2378. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  2379. @end example
  2380. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  2381. 7-channels surround:
  2382. @example
  2383. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  2384. @end example
  2385. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  2386. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  2387. needs.
  2388. @subsection Remapping examples
  2389. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  2390. @itemize
  2391. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  2392. @item only one input per channel output,
  2393. @end itemize
  2394. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  2395. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  2396. remapping.
  2397. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  2398. dropping the extra channels:
  2399. @example
  2400. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  2401. @end example
  2402. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  2403. and keep the input channel layout:
  2404. @example
  2405. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  2406. @end example
  2407. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  2408. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  2409. @example
  2410. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  2411. @end example
  2412. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  2413. front left and right:
  2414. @example
  2415. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  2416. @end example
  2417. @section replaygain
  2418. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  2419. outputs it unchanged.
  2420. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  2421. @section resample
  2422. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  2423. not meant to be used directly.
  2424. @section rubberband
  2425. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  2426. The filter accepts the following options:
  2427. @table @option
  2428. @item tempo
  2429. Set tempo scale factor.
  2430. @item pitch
  2431. Set pitch scale factor.
  2432. @item transients
  2433. Set transients detector.
  2434. Possible values are:
  2435. @table @var
  2436. @item crisp
  2437. @item mixed
  2438. @item smooth
  2439. @end table
  2440. @item detector
  2441. Set detector.
  2442. Possible values are:
  2443. @table @var
  2444. @item compound
  2445. @item percussive
  2446. @item soft
  2447. @end table
  2448. @item phase
  2449. Set phase.
  2450. Possible values are:
  2451. @table @var
  2452. @item laminar
  2453. @item independent
  2454. @end table
  2455. @item window
  2456. Set processing window size.
  2457. Possible values are:
  2458. @table @var
  2459. @item standard
  2460. @item short
  2461. @item long
  2462. @end table
  2463. @item smoothing
  2464. Set smoothing.
  2465. Possible values are:
  2466. @table @var
  2467. @item off
  2468. @item on
  2469. @end table
  2470. @item formant
  2471. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  2472. Possible values are:
  2473. @table @var
  2474. @item shifted
  2475. @item preserved
  2476. @end table
  2477. @item pitchq
  2478. Set pitch quality.
  2479. Possible values are:
  2480. @table @var
  2481. @item quality
  2482. @item speed
  2483. @item consistency
  2484. @end table
  2485. @item channels
  2486. Set channels.
  2487. Possible values are:
  2488. @table @var
  2489. @item apart
  2490. @item together
  2491. @end table
  2492. @end table
  2493. @section sidechaincompress
  2494. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  2495. detected signal using second input signal.
  2496. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2497. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2498. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  2499. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  2500. The filter accepts the following options:
  2501. @table @option
  2502. @item level_in
  2503. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2504. @item threshold
  2505. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  2506. reduction of first stream.
  2507. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  2508. @item ratio
  2509. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  2510. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  2511. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  2512. @item attack
  2513. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2514. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  2515. @item release
  2516. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  2517. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  2518. @item makeup
  2519. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  2520. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  2521. @item knee
  2522. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2523. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  2524. @item link
  2525. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  2526. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  2527. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  2528. @item detection
  2529. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  2530. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  2531. @item level_sc
  2532. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2533. @item mix
  2534. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  2535. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2536. @end table
  2537. @subsection Examples
  2538. @itemize
  2539. @item
  2540. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  2541. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  2542. merged with 2nd input:
  2543. @example
  2544. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  2545. @end example
  2546. @end itemize
  2547. @section sidechaingate
  2548. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  2549. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  2550. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  2551. threshold.
  2552. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  2553. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  2554. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  2555. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  2556. guitar.
  2557. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2558. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2559. The filter accepts the following options:
  2560. @table @option
  2561. @item level_in
  2562. Set input level before filtering.
  2563. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2564. @item range
  2565. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  2566. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2567. @item threshold
  2568. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  2569. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2570. @item ratio
  2571. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  2572. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  2573. @item attack
  2574. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2575. reduction stops.
  2576. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2577. @item release
  2578. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  2579. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  2580. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2581. @item makeup
  2582. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  2583. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  2584. @item knee
  2585. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2586. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  2587. @item detection
  2588. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  2589. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  2590. @item link
  2591. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  2592. the reduction.
  2593. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  2594. @item level_sc
  2595. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2596. @end table
  2597. @section silencedetect
  2598. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  2599. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  2600. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  2601. minimum detected noise duration.
  2602. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
  2603. The filter accepts the following options:
  2604. @table @option
  2605. @item duration, d
  2606. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  2607. @item noise, n
  2608. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  2609. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  2610. @end table
  2611. @subsection Examples
  2612. @itemize
  2613. @item
  2614. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  2615. @example
  2616. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  2617. @end example
  2618. @item
  2619. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  2620. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  2621. @example
  2622. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  2623. @end example
  2624. @end itemize
  2625. @section silenceremove
  2626. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  2627. The filter accepts the following options:
  2628. @table @option
  2629. @item start_periods
  2630. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  2631. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  2632. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  2633. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  2634. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  2635. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  2636. Default value is @code{0}.
  2637. @item start_duration
  2638. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  2639. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  2640. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  2641. @item start_threshold
  2642. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  2643. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  2644. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  2645. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2646. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2647. @item stop_periods
  2648. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  2649. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  2650. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  2651. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  2652. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  2653. in the middle of the audio.
  2654. Default value is @code{0}.
  2655. @item stop_duration
  2656. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  2657. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  2658. the audio.
  2659. Default value is @code{0}.
  2660. @item stop_threshold
  2661. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  2662. the end of audio.
  2663. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2664. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2665. @item leave_silence
  2666. This indicate that @var{stop_duration} length of audio should be left intact
  2667. at the beginning of each period of silence.
  2668. For example, if you want to remove long pauses between words but do not want
  2669. to remove the pauses completely. Default value is @code{0}.
  2670. @item detection
  2671. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  2672. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  2673. Default value is @code{rms}.
  2674. @item window
  2675. Set ratio used to calculate size of window for detecting silence.
  2676. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  2677. @end table
  2678. @subsection Examples
  2679. @itemize
  2680. @item
  2681. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  2682. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  2683. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  2684. @example
  2685. silenceremove=1:5:0.02
  2686. @end example
  2687. @item
  2688. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  2689. second of silence in audio:
  2690. @example
  2691. silenceremove=0:0:0:-1:1:-90dB
  2692. @end example
  2693. @end itemize
  2694. @section sofalizer
  2695. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2696. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  2697. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  2698. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  2699. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  2700. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  2701. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2702. @code{--enable-netcdf}.
  2703. The filter accepts the following options:
  2704. @table @option
  2705. @item sofa
  2706. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  2707. @item gain
  2708. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2709. @item rotation
  2710. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2711. @item elevation
  2712. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2713. @item radius
  2714. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  2715. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  2716. @item type
  2717. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2718. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  2719. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  2720. Default is @var{freq}.
  2721. @item speakers
  2722. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  2723. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  2724. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  2725. azimuth and elevation in degreees.
  2726. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  2727. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  2728. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  2729. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  2730. @end table
  2731. @subsection Examples
  2732. @itemize
  2733. @item
  2734. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  2735. @example
  2736. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  2737. @end example
  2738. @item
  2739. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  2740. @example
  2741. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  2742. @end example
  2743. @item
  2744. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, rear left and rear right
  2745. and also with custom gain:
  2746. @example
  2747. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|RL 135|RR 225:gain=28"
  2748. @end example
  2749. @end itemize
  2750. @section stereotools
  2751. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  2752. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  2753. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  2754. The filter accepts the following options:
  2755. @table @option
  2756. @item level_in
  2757. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2758. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2759. @item level_out
  2760. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2761. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2762. @item balance_in
  2763. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2764. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2765. @item balance_out
  2766. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2767. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2768. @item softclip
  2769. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  2770. clipping. Disabled by default.
  2771. @item mutel
  2772. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2773. @item muter
  2774. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2775. @item phasel
  2776. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2777. @item phaser
  2778. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2779. @item mode
  2780. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  2781. @table @samp
  2782. @item lr>lr
  2783. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  2784. @item lr>ms
  2785. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  2786. @item ms>lr
  2787. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  2788. @item lr>ll
  2789. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  2790. @item lr>rr
  2791. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  2792. @item lr>l+r
  2793. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  2794. @item lr>rl
  2795. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  2796. @end table
  2797. @item slev
  2798. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  2799. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2800. @item sbal
  2801. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  2802. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2803. @item mlev
  2804. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  2805. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2806. @item mpan
  2807. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2808. @item base
  2809. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  2810. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2811. @item delay
  2812. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  2813. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  2814. @item sclevel
  2815. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  2816. @item phase
  2817. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  2818. @end table
  2819. @subsection Examples
  2820. @itemize
  2821. @item
  2822. Apply karaoke like effect:
  2823. @example
  2824. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  2825. @end example
  2826. @item
  2827. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  2828. @example
  2829. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  2830. @end example
  2831. @end itemize
  2832. @section stereowiden
  2833. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  2834. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  2835. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  2836. The filter accepts the following options:
  2837. @table @option
  2838. @item delay
  2839. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  2840. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  2841. @item feedback
  2842. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  2843. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  2844. effect. Default is 0.3.
  2845. @item crossfeed
  2846. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  2847. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  2848. channels. Default is 0.3.
  2849. @item drymix
  2850. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  2851. @end table
  2852. @section treble
  2853. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2854. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2855. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2856. The filter accepts the following options:
  2857. @table @option
  2858. @item gain, g
  2859. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  2860. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  2861. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2862. @item frequency, f
  2863. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2864. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2865. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  2866. @item width_type
  2867. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2868. @table @option
  2869. @item h
  2870. Hz
  2871. @item q
  2872. Q-Factor
  2873. @item o
  2874. octave
  2875. @item s
  2876. slope
  2877. @end table
  2878. @item width, w
  2879. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2880. @end table
  2881. @section tremolo
  2882. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  2883. The filter accepts the following options:
  2884. @table @option
  2885. @item f
  2886. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  2887. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  2888. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  2889. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  2890. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2891. @item d
  2892. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2893. Default value is 0.5.
  2894. @end table
  2895. @section vibrato
  2896. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  2897. The filter accepts the following options:
  2898. @table @option
  2899. @item f
  2900. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  2901. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2902. @item d
  2903. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2904. Default value is 0.5.
  2905. @end table
  2906. @section volume
  2907. Adjust the input audio volume.
  2908. It accepts the following parameters:
  2909. @table @option
  2910. @item volume
  2911. Set audio volume expression.
  2912. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  2913. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  2914. @example
  2915. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  2916. @end example
  2917. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  2918. @item precision
  2919. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  2920. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  2921. precision of the volume scaling.
  2922. @table @option
  2923. @item fixed
  2924. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  2925. @item float
  2926. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  2927. @item double
  2928. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  2929. @end table
  2930. @item replaygain
  2931. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  2932. @table @option
  2933. @item drop
  2934. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  2935. @item ignore
  2936. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  2937. @item track
  2938. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  2939. @item album
  2940. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  2941. @end table
  2942. @item replaygain_preamp
  2943. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  2944. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  2945. @item eval
  2946. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  2947. It accepts the following values:
  2948. @table @samp
  2949. @item once
  2950. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  2951. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  2952. @item frame
  2953. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  2954. @end table
  2955. Default value is @samp{once}.
  2956. @end table
  2957. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  2958. @table @option
  2959. @item n
  2960. frame number (starting at zero)
  2961. @item nb_channels
  2962. number of channels
  2963. @item nb_consumed_samples
  2964. number of samples consumed by the filter
  2965. @item nb_samples
  2966. number of samples in the current frame
  2967. @item pos
  2968. original frame position in the file
  2969. @item pts
  2970. frame PTS
  2971. @item sample_rate
  2972. sample rate
  2973. @item startpts
  2974. PTS at start of stream
  2975. @item startt
  2976. time at start of stream
  2977. @item t
  2978. frame time
  2979. @item tb
  2980. timestamp timebase
  2981. @item volume
  2982. last set volume value
  2983. @end table
  2984. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  2985. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  2986. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  2987. @subsection Commands
  2988. This filter supports the following commands:
  2989. @table @option
  2990. @item volume
  2991. Modify the volume expression.
  2992. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  2993. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  2994. value.
  2995. @item replaygain_noclip
  2996. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  2997. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  2998. @end table
  2999. @subsection Examples
  3000. @itemize
  3001. @item
  3002. Halve the input audio volume:
  3003. @example
  3004. volume=volume=0.5
  3005. volume=volume=1/2
  3006. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  3007. @end example
  3008. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  3009. omitted, for example like in:
  3010. @example
  3011. volume=0.5
  3012. @end example
  3013. @item
  3014. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  3015. @example
  3016. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  3017. @end example
  3018. @item
  3019. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  3020. @example
  3021. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  3022. @end example
  3023. @end itemize
  3024. @section volumedetect
  3025. Detect the volume of the input video.
  3026. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  3027. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  3028. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  3029. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  3030. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  3031. the samples).
  3032. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  3033. @subsection Examples
  3034. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  3035. @example
  3036. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  3037. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  3038. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  3039. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  3040. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  3041. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  3042. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  3043. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  3044. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  3045. @end example
  3046. It means that:
  3047. @itemize
  3048. @item
  3049. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  3050. @item
  3051. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  3052. @item
  3053. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  3054. @end itemize
  3055. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  3056. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  3057. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  3058. @chapter Audio Sources
  3059. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  3060. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  3061. @section abuffer
  3062. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  3063. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  3064. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  3065. It accepts the following parameters:
  3066. @table @option
  3067. @item time_base
  3068. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  3069. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  3070. @item sample_rate
  3071. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  3072. @item sample_fmt
  3073. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  3074. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  3075. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  3076. @item channel_layout
  3077. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  3078. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  3079. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  3080. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  3081. @item channels
  3082. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  3083. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  3084. must be consistent.
  3085. @end table
  3086. @subsection Examples
  3087. @example
  3088. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  3089. @end example
  3090. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  3091. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  3092. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  3093. equivalent to:
  3094. @example
  3095. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  3096. @end example
  3097. @section aevalsrc
  3098. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  3099. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  3100. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  3101. audio signal.
  3102. This source accepts the following options:
  3103. @table @option
  3104. @item exprs
  3105. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  3106. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  3107. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  3108. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  3109. @item channel_layout, c
  3110. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  3111. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  3112. @item duration, d
  3113. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3114. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3115. for the accepted syntax.
  3116. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  3117. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  3118. complete frame.
  3119. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3120. supposed to be generated forever.
  3121. @item nb_samples, n
  3122. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  3123. default to 1024.
  3124. @item sample_rate, s
  3125. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  3126. @end table
  3127. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  3128. @table @option
  3129. @item n
  3130. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  3131. @item t
  3132. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  3133. @item s
  3134. sample rate
  3135. @end table
  3136. @subsection Examples
  3137. @itemize
  3138. @item
  3139. Generate silence:
  3140. @example
  3141. aevalsrc=0
  3142. @end example
  3143. @item
  3144. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  3145. 8000 Hz:
  3146. @example
  3147. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  3148. @end example
  3149. @item
  3150. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  3151. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  3152. @example
  3153. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  3154. @end example
  3155. @item
  3156. Generate white noise:
  3157. @example
  3158. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  3159. @end example
  3160. @item
  3161. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  3162. @example
  3163. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  3164. @end example
  3165. @item
  3166. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  3167. @example
  3168. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  3169. @end example
  3170. @end itemize
  3171. @section anullsrc
  3172. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  3173. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  3174. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  3175. synth filter).
  3176. This source accepts the following options:
  3177. @table @option
  3178. @item channel_layout, cl
  3179. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  3180. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  3181. is "stereo".
  3182. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  3183. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  3184. channel layout values.
  3185. @item sample_rate, r
  3186. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  3187. @item nb_samples, n
  3188. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  3189. @end table
  3190. @subsection Examples
  3191. @itemize
  3192. @item
  3193. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  3194. @example
  3195. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  3196. @end example
  3197. @item
  3198. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  3199. @example
  3200. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  3201. @end example
  3202. @end itemize
  3203. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  3204. @section flite
  3205. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  3206. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3207. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  3208. Note that the flite library is not thread-safe.
  3209. The filter accepts the following options:
  3210. @table @option
  3211. @item list_voices
  3212. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  3213. immediately. Default value is 0.
  3214. @item nb_samples, n
  3215. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  3216. @item textfile
  3217. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  3218. @item text
  3219. Set the text to speak.
  3220. @item voice, v
  3221. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  3222. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  3223. @end table
  3224. @subsection Examples
  3225. @itemize
  3226. @item
  3227. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  3228. standard flite voice:
  3229. @example
  3230. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  3231. @end example
  3232. @item
  3233. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  3234. @example
  3235. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3236. @end example
  3237. @item
  3238. Input text to ffmpeg:
  3239. @example
  3240. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3241. @end example
  3242. @item
  3243. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  3244. the @code{lavfi} device:
  3245. @example
  3246. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  3247. @end example
  3248. @end itemize
  3249. For more information about libflite, check:
  3250. @url{http://www.speech.cs.cmu.edu/flite/}
  3251. @section anoisesrc
  3252. Generate a noise audio signal.
  3253. The filter accepts the following options:
  3254. @table @option
  3255. @item sample_rate, r
  3256. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  3257. @item amplitude, a
  3258. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  3259. is 1.0.
  3260. @item duration, d
  3261. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  3262. results in noise with an infinite length.
  3263. @item color, colour, c
  3264. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, and brown.
  3265. Default color is white.
  3266. @item seed, s
  3267. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  3268. @item nb_samples, n
  3269. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  3270. @end table
  3271. @subsection Examples
  3272. @itemize
  3273. @item
  3274. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  3275. @example
  3276. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  3277. @end example
  3278. @end itemize
  3279. @section sine
  3280. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  3281. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  3282. The filter accepts the following options:
  3283. @table @option
  3284. @item frequency, f
  3285. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  3286. @item beep_factor, b
  3287. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  3288. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  3289. @item sample_rate, r
  3290. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  3291. @item duration, d
  3292. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  3293. @item samples_per_frame
  3294. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  3295. The expression can contain the following constants:
  3296. @table @option
  3297. @item n
  3298. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  3299. @item pts
  3300. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  3301. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  3302. @item t
  3303. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  3304. @item TB
  3305. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  3306. @end table
  3307. Default is @code{1024}.
  3308. @end table
  3309. @subsection Examples
  3310. @itemize
  3311. @item
  3312. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  3313. @example
  3314. sine
  3315. @end example
  3316. @item
  3317. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  3318. @example
  3319. sine=220:4:d=5
  3320. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  3321. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  3322. @end example
  3323. @item
  3324. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  3325. pattern:
  3326. @example
  3327. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  3328. @end example
  3329. @end itemize
  3330. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  3331. @chapter Audio Sinks
  3332. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  3333. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  3334. @section abuffersink
  3335. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  3336. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  3337. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  3338. or the options system.
  3339. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  3340. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  3341. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  3342. @section anullsink
  3343. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  3344. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  3345. tools.
  3346. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  3347. @chapter Video Filters
  3348. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  3349. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  3350. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  3351. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  3352. build.
  3353. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  3354. @section alphaextract
  3355. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  3356. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  3357. @section alphamerge
  3358. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  3359. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  3360. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  3361. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  3362. channel.
  3363. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  3364. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  3365. @example
  3366. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  3367. @end example
  3368. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  3369. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  3370. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  3371. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  3372. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  3373. @section ass
  3374. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  3375. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  3376. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  3377. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  3378. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  3379. @table @option
  3380. @item shaping
  3381. Set the shaping engine
  3382. Available values are:
  3383. @table @samp
  3384. @item auto
  3385. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  3386. @item simple
  3387. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  3388. @item complex
  3389. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  3390. @end table
  3391. The default is @code{auto}.
  3392. @end table
  3393. @section atadenoise
  3394. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  3395. The filter accepts the following options:
  3396. @table @option
  3397. @item 0a
  3398. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  3399. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3400. @item 0b
  3401. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  3402. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3403. @item 1a
  3404. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3405. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3406. @item 1b
  3407. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3408. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3409. @item 2a
  3410. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3411. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3412. @item 2b
  3413. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3414. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3415. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  3416. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  3417. @item s
  3418. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 33. Must be odd
  3419. number in range [5, 129].
  3420. @item p
  3421. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  3422. @end table
  3423. @section avgblur
  3424. Apply average blur filter.
  3425. The filter accepts the following options:
  3426. @table @option
  3427. @item sizeX
  3428. Set horizontal kernel size.
  3429. @item planes
  3430. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  3431. @item sizeY
  3432. Set vertical kernel size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  3433. Default is @code{0}.
  3434. @end table
  3435. @section bbox
  3436. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  3437. luminance plane.
  3438. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  3439. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  3440. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  3441. log.
  3442. The filter accepts the following option:
  3443. @table @option
  3444. @item min_val
  3445. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  3446. @end table
  3447. @section bitplanenoise
  3448. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  3449. The filter accepts the following options:
  3450. @table @option
  3451. @item bitplane
  3452. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  3453. @item filter
  3454. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  3455. Default is disabled.
  3456. @end table
  3457. @section blackdetect
  3458. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  3459. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  3460. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  3461. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  3462. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3463. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3464. The filter accepts the following options:
  3465. @table @option
  3466. @item black_min_duration, d
  3467. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  3468. be a non-negative floating point number.
  3469. Default value is 2.0.
  3470. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  3471. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  3472. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  3473. @example
  3474. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  3475. @end example
  3476. for which a picture is considered black.
  3477. Default value is 0.98.
  3478. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  3479. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  3480. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  3481. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  3482. the following equation:
  3483. @example
  3484. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  3485. @end example
  3486. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  3487. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  3488. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  3489. Default value is 0.10.
  3490. @end table
  3491. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  3492. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  3493. @example
  3494. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  3495. @end example
  3496. @section blackframe
  3497. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  3498. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  3499. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  3500. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  3501. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3502. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3503. It accepts the following parameters:
  3504. @table @option
  3505. @item amount
  3506. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  3507. @code{98}.
  3508. @item threshold, thresh
  3509. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  3510. @code{32}.
  3511. @end table
  3512. @section blend, tblend
  3513. Blend two video frames into each other.
  3514. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  3515. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  3516. "bottom" layer. Output terminates when shortest input terminates.
  3517. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  3518. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  3519. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  3520. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3521. @table @option
  3522. @item c0_mode
  3523. @item c1_mode
  3524. @item c2_mode
  3525. @item c3_mode
  3526. @item all_mode
  3527. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3528. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  3529. Available values for component modes are:
  3530. @table @samp
  3531. @item addition
  3532. @item addition128
  3533. @item and
  3534. @item average
  3535. @item burn
  3536. @item darken
  3537. @item difference
  3538. @item difference128
  3539. @item divide
  3540. @item dodge
  3541. @item freeze
  3542. @item exclusion
  3543. @item glow
  3544. @item hardlight
  3545. @item hardmix
  3546. @item heat
  3547. @item lighten
  3548. @item linearlight
  3549. @item multiply
  3550. @item multiply128
  3551. @item negation
  3552. @item normal
  3553. @item or
  3554. @item overlay
  3555. @item phoenix
  3556. @item pinlight
  3557. @item reflect
  3558. @item screen
  3559. @item softlight
  3560. @item subtract
  3561. @item vividlight
  3562. @item xor
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item c0_opacity
  3565. @item c1_opacity
  3566. @item c2_opacity
  3567. @item c3_opacity
  3568. @item all_opacity
  3569. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3570. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  3571. @item c0_expr
  3572. @item c1_expr
  3573. @item c2_expr
  3574. @item c3_expr
  3575. @item all_expr
  3576. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3577. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  3578. The expressions can use the following variables:
  3579. @table @option
  3580. @item N
  3581. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  3582. @item X
  3583. @item Y
  3584. the coordinates of the current sample
  3585. @item W
  3586. @item H
  3587. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  3588. @item SW
  3589. @item SH
  3590. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  3591. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  3592. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  3593. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  3594. @item T
  3595. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  3596. @item TOP, A
  3597. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  3598. @item BOTTOM, B
  3599. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  3600. @end table
  3601. @item shortest
  3602. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is
  3603. @code{0}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3604. @item repeatlast
  3605. Continue applying the last bottom frame after the end of the stream. A value of
  3606. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the bottom layer is reached.
  3607. Default is @code{1}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3608. @end table
  3609. @subsection Examples
  3610. @itemize
  3611. @item
  3612. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  3613. @example
  3614. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  3615. @end example
  3616. @item
  3617. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  3618. @example
  3619. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  3620. @end example
  3621. @item
  3622. Apply uncover left effect:
  3623. @example
  3624. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  3625. @end example
  3626. @item
  3627. Apply uncover down effect:
  3628. @example
  3629. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  3630. @end example
  3631. @item
  3632. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  3633. @example
  3634. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  3635. @end example
  3636. @item
  3637. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  3638. @example
  3639. blend=all_expr=if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)
  3640. @end example
  3641. @item
  3642. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  3643. @example
  3644. tblend=all_mode=difference128
  3645. @end example
  3646. @end itemize
  3647. @section boxblur
  3648. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  3649. It accepts the following parameters:
  3650. @table @option
  3651. @item luma_radius, lr
  3652. @item luma_power, lp
  3653. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3654. @item chroma_power, cp
  3655. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3656. @item alpha_power, ap
  3657. @end table
  3658. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3659. @table @option
  3660. @item luma_radius, lr
  3661. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3662. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3663. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  3664. corresponding input plane.
  3665. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  3666. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  3667. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  3668. planes.
  3669. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  3670. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  3671. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  3672. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  3673. @table @option
  3674. @item w
  3675. @item h
  3676. The input width and height in pixels.
  3677. @item cw
  3678. @item ch
  3679. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  3680. @item hsub
  3681. @item vsub
  3682. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  3683. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  3684. @end table
  3685. @item luma_power, lp
  3686. @item chroma_power, cp
  3687. @item alpha_power, ap
  3688. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  3689. corresponding plane.
  3690. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  3691. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  3692. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  3693. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  3694. @end table
  3695. @subsection Examples
  3696. @itemize
  3697. @item
  3698. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  3699. set to 2:
  3700. @example
  3701. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  3702. boxblur=2:1
  3703. @end example
  3704. @item
  3705. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  3706. @example
  3707. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  3708. @end example
  3709. @item
  3710. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  3711. @example
  3712. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  3713. @end example
  3714. @end itemize
  3715. @section bwdif
  3716. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  3717. Deinterlacing Filter").
  3718. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  3719. interpolation algorithms.
  3720. It accepts the following parameters:
  3721. @table @option
  3722. @item mode
  3723. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  3724. @table @option
  3725. @item 0, send_frame
  3726. Output one frame for each frame.
  3727. @item 1, send_field
  3728. Output one frame for each field.
  3729. @end table
  3730. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  3731. @item parity
  3732. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  3733. of the following values:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item 0, tff
  3736. Assume the top field is first.
  3737. @item 1, bff
  3738. Assume the bottom field is first.
  3739. @item -1, auto
  3740. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  3741. @end table
  3742. The default value is @code{auto}.
  3743. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  3744. top field first will be assumed.
  3745. @item deint
  3746. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  3747. values:
  3748. @table @option
  3749. @item 0, all
  3750. Deinterlace all frames.
  3751. @item 1, interlaced
  3752. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  3753. @end table
  3754. The default value is @code{all}.
  3755. @end table
  3756. @section chromakey
  3757. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  3758. The filter accepts the following options:
  3759. @table @option
  3760. @item color
  3761. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3762. @item similarity
  3763. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3764. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3765. @item blend
  3766. Blend percentage.
  3767. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3768. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3769. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3770. @item yuv
  3771. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  3772. Litteral colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  3773. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  3774. @end table
  3775. @subsection Examples
  3776. @itemize
  3777. @item
  3778. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3779. @example
  3780. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  3781. @end example
  3782. @item
  3783. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  3784. @example
  3785. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  3786. @end example
  3787. @end itemize
  3788. @section ciescope
  3789. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  3790. The filter accepts the following options:
  3791. @table @option
  3792. @item system
  3793. Set color system.
  3794. @table @samp
  3795. @item ntsc, 470m
  3796. @item ebu, 470bg
  3797. @item smpte
  3798. @item 240m
  3799. @item apple
  3800. @item widergb
  3801. @item cie1931
  3802. @item rec709, hdtv
  3803. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  3804. @end table
  3805. @item cie
  3806. Set CIE system.
  3807. @table @samp
  3808. @item xyy
  3809. @item ucs
  3810. @item luv
  3811. @end table
  3812. @item gamuts
  3813. Set what gamuts to draw.
  3814. See @code{system} option for available values.
  3815. @item size, s
  3816. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  3817. @item intensity, i
  3818. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  3819. @item contrast
  3820. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  3821. @item corrgamma
  3822. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  3823. @item showwhite
  3824. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  3825. @item gamma
  3826. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  3827. @end table
  3828. @section codecview
  3829. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  3830. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  3831. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  3832. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  3833. The filter accepts the following option:
  3834. @table @option
  3835. @item mv
  3836. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  3837. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  3838. @table @samp
  3839. @item pf
  3840. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  3841. @item bf
  3842. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3843. @item bb
  3844. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3845. @end table
  3846. @item qp
  3847. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  3848. @item mv_type, mvt
  3849. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  3850. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  3851. @table @samp
  3852. @item fp
  3853. forward predicted MVs
  3854. @item bp
  3855. backward predicted MVs
  3856. @end table
  3857. @item frame_type, ft
  3858. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  3859. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  3860. @table @samp
  3861. @item if
  3862. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  3863. @item pf
  3864. predicted frames (P-frames)
  3865. @item bf
  3866. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  3867. @end table
  3868. @end table
  3869. @subsection Examples
  3870. @itemize
  3871. @item
  3872. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  3873. @example
  3874. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  3875. @end example
  3876. @item
  3877. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  3878. @example
  3879. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  3880. @end example
  3881. @end itemize
  3882. @section colorbalance
  3883. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  3884. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  3885. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  3886. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  3887. value towards the complementary color.
  3888. The filter accepts the following options:
  3889. @table @option
  3890. @item rs
  3891. @item gs
  3892. @item bs
  3893. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  3894. @item rm
  3895. @item gm
  3896. @item bm
  3897. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  3898. @item rh
  3899. @item gh
  3900. @item bh
  3901. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  3902. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3903. @end table
  3904. @subsection Examples
  3905. @itemize
  3906. @item
  3907. Add red color cast to shadows:
  3908. @example
  3909. colorbalance=rs=.3
  3910. @end example
  3911. @end itemize
  3912. @section colorkey
  3913. RGB colorspace color keying.
  3914. The filter accepts the following options:
  3915. @table @option
  3916. @item color
  3917. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3918. @item similarity
  3919. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3920. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3921. @item blend
  3922. Blend percentage.
  3923. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3924. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3925. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3926. @end table
  3927. @subsection Examples
  3928. @itemize
  3929. @item
  3930. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3931. @example
  3932. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  3933. @end example
  3934. @item
  3935. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  3936. @example
  3937. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  3938. @end example
  3939. @end itemize
  3940. @section colorlevels
  3941. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  3942. The filter accepts the following options:
  3943. @table @option
  3944. @item rimin
  3945. @item gimin
  3946. @item bimin
  3947. @item aimin
  3948. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  3949. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3950. @item rimax
  3951. @item gimax
  3952. @item bimax
  3953. @item aimax
  3954. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  3955. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3956. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  3957. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  3958. @item romin
  3959. @item gomin
  3960. @item bomin
  3961. @item aomin
  3962. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  3963. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3964. @item romax
  3965. @item gomax
  3966. @item bomax
  3967. @item aomax
  3968. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  3969. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3970. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  3971. @end table
  3972. @subsection Examples
  3973. @itemize
  3974. @item
  3975. Make video output darker:
  3976. @example
  3977. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  3978. @end example
  3979. @item
  3980. Increase contrast:
  3981. @example
  3982. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  3983. @end example
  3984. @item
  3985. Make video output lighter:
  3986. @example
  3987. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  3988. @end example
  3989. @item
  3990. Increase brightness:
  3991. @example
  3992. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  3993. @end example
  3994. @end itemize
  3995. @section colorchannelmixer
  3996. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  3997. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  3998. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  3999. modify is red, the output value will be:
  4000. @example
  4001. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  4002. @end example
  4003. The filter accepts the following options:
  4004. @table @option
  4005. @item rr
  4006. @item rg
  4007. @item rb
  4008. @item ra
  4009. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  4010. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  4011. @item gr
  4012. @item gg
  4013. @item gb
  4014. @item ga
  4015. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  4016. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  4017. @item br
  4018. @item bg
  4019. @item bb
  4020. @item ba
  4021. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  4022. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  4023. @item ar
  4024. @item ag
  4025. @item ab
  4026. @item aa
  4027. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  4028. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  4029. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  4030. @end table
  4031. @subsection Examples
  4032. @itemize
  4033. @item
  4034. Convert source to grayscale:
  4035. @example
  4036. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  4037. @end example
  4038. @item
  4039. Simulate sepia tones:
  4040. @example
  4041. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  4042. @end example
  4043. @end itemize
  4044. @section colormatrix
  4045. Convert color matrix.
  4046. The filter accepts the following options:
  4047. @table @option
  4048. @item src
  4049. @item dst
  4050. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  4051. specified.
  4052. The accepted values are:
  4053. @table @samp
  4054. @item bt709
  4055. BT.709
  4056. @item bt601
  4057. BT.601
  4058. @item smpte240m
  4059. SMPTE-240M
  4060. @item fcc
  4061. FCC
  4062. @item bt2020
  4063. BT.2020
  4064. @end table
  4065. @end table
  4066. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  4067. @example
  4068. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  4069. @end example
  4070. @section colorspace
  4071. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  4072. The filter accepts the following options:
  4073. @table @option
  4074. @anchor{all}
  4075. @item all
  4076. Specify all color properties at once.
  4077. The accepted values are:
  4078. @table @samp
  4079. @item bt470m
  4080. BT.470M
  4081. @item bt470bg
  4082. BT.470BG
  4083. @item bt601-6-525
  4084. BT.601-6 525
  4085. @item bt601-6-625
  4086. BT.601-6 625
  4087. @item bt709
  4088. BT.709
  4089. @item smpte170m
  4090. SMPTE-170M
  4091. @item smpte240m
  4092. SMPTE-240M
  4093. @item bt2020
  4094. BT.2020
  4095. @end table
  4096. @anchor{space}
  4097. @item space
  4098. Specify output colorspace.
  4099. The accepted values are:
  4100. @table @samp
  4101. @item bt709
  4102. BT.709
  4103. @item fcc
  4104. FCC
  4105. @item bt470bg
  4106. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  4107. @item smpte170m
  4108. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  4109. @item smpte240m
  4110. SMPTE-240M
  4111. @item bt2020ncl
  4112. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  4113. @end table
  4114. @anchor{trc}
  4115. @item trc
  4116. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  4117. The accepted values are:
  4118. @table @samp
  4119. @item bt709
  4120. BT.709
  4121. @item gamma22
  4122. Constant gamma of 2.2
  4123. @item gamma28
  4124. Constant gamma of 2.8
  4125. @item smpte170m
  4126. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  4127. @item smpte240m
  4128. SMPTE-240M
  4129. @item bt2020-10
  4130. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  4131. @item bt2020-12
  4132. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  4133. @end table
  4134. @anchor{primaries}
  4135. @item primaries
  4136. Specify output color primaries.
  4137. The accepted values are:
  4138. @table @samp
  4139. @item bt709
  4140. BT.709
  4141. @item bt470m
  4142. BT.470M
  4143. @item bt470bg
  4144. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  4145. @item smpte170m
  4146. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  4147. @item smpte240m
  4148. SMPTE-240M
  4149. @item bt2020
  4150. BT.2020
  4151. @end table
  4152. @anchor{range}
  4153. @item range
  4154. Specify output color range.
  4155. The accepted values are:
  4156. @table @samp
  4157. @item mpeg
  4158. MPEG (restricted) range
  4159. @item jpeg
  4160. JPEG (full) range
  4161. @end table
  4162. @item format
  4163. Specify output color format.
  4164. The accepted values are:
  4165. @table @samp
  4166. @item yuv420p
  4167. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  4168. @item yuv420p10
  4169. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  4170. @item yuv420p12
  4171. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  4172. @item yuv422p
  4173. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  4174. @item yuv422p10
  4175. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  4176. @item yuv422p12
  4177. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  4178. @item yuv444p
  4179. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  4180. @item yuv444p10
  4181. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  4182. @item yuv444p12
  4183. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  4184. @end table
  4185. @item fast
  4186. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  4187. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  4188. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  4189. @item dither
  4190. Specify dithering mode.
  4191. The accepted values are:
  4192. @table @samp
  4193. @item none
  4194. No dithering
  4195. @item fsb
  4196. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  4197. @end table
  4198. @item wpadapt
  4199. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  4200. The accepted values are:
  4201. @table @samp
  4202. @item bradford
  4203. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  4204. @item vonkries
  4205. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  4206. @item identity
  4207. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  4208. @end table
  4209. @item iall
  4210. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  4211. @item ispace
  4212. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  4213. @item iprimaries
  4214. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  4215. @item itrc
  4216. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  4217. @item irange
  4218. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  4219. @end table
  4220. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  4221. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  4222. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  4223. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  4224. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  4225. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  4226. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  4227. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  4228. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  4229. @example
  4230. colorspace=smpte240m
  4231. @end example
  4232. @section convolution
  4233. Apply convolution 3x3 or 5x5 filter.
  4234. The filter accepts the following options:
  4235. @table @option
  4236. @item 0m
  4237. @item 1m
  4238. @item 2m
  4239. @item 3m
  4240. Set matrix for each plane.
  4241. Matrix is sequence of 9 or 25 signed integers.
  4242. @item 0rdiv
  4243. @item 1rdiv
  4244. @item 2rdiv
  4245. @item 3rdiv
  4246. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  4247. @item 0bias
  4248. @item 1bias
  4249. @item 2bias
  4250. @item 3bias
  4251. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  4252. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  4253. @end table
  4254. @subsection Examples
  4255. @itemize
  4256. @item
  4257. Apply sharpen:
  4258. @example
  4259. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  4260. @end example
  4261. @item
  4262. Apply blur:
  4263. @example
  4264. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  4265. @end example
  4266. @item
  4267. Apply edge enhance:
  4268. @example
  4269. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  4270. @end example
  4271. @item
  4272. Apply edge detect:
  4273. @example
  4274. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  4275. @end example
  4276. @item
  4277. Apply emboss:
  4278. @example
  4279. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  4280. @end example
  4281. @end itemize
  4282. @section copy
  4283. Copy the input source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  4284. testing purposes.
  4285. @anchor{coreimage}
  4286. @section coreimage
  4287. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  4288. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  4289. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  4290. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  4291. the respective OSX.
  4292. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  4293. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  4294. with its options.
  4295. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  4296. @table @option
  4297. @item list_filters
  4298. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  4299. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  4300. values.
  4301. @example
  4302. list_filters=true
  4303. @end example
  4304. @item filter
  4305. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  4306. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  4307. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  4308. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  4309. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  4310. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  4311. filter.
  4312. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  4313. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  4314. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  4315. @example
  4316. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  4317. @end example
  4318. @item output_rect
  4319. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  4320. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  4321. @example
  4322. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  4323. @end example
  4324. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  4325. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  4326. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  4327. @example
  4328. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  4329. @end example
  4330. @end table
  4331. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  4332. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  4333. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  4334. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  4335. usable as intended.
  4336. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  4337. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  4338. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  4339. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  4340. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  4341. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  4342. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  4343. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  4344. output image.
  4345. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  4346. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  4347. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  4348. @subsection Examples
  4349. @itemize
  4350. @item
  4351. List all filters available:
  4352. @example
  4353. coreimage=list_filters=true
  4354. @end example
  4355. @item
  4356. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  4357. @example
  4358. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  4359. @end example
  4360. @item
  4361. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  4362. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  4363. @example
  4364. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  4365. @end example
  4366. @item
  4367. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  4368. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  4369. @example
  4370. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  4371. @end example
  4372. @end itemize
  4373. @section crop
  4374. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  4375. It accepts the following parameters:
  4376. @table @option
  4377. @item w, out_w
  4378. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  4379. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  4380. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  4381. @item h, out_h
  4382. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  4383. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  4384. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  4385. @item x
  4386. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  4387. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  4388. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  4389. @item y
  4390. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  4391. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  4392. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  4393. @item keep_aspect
  4394. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  4395. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  4396. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  4397. @item exact
  4398. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  4399. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  4400. It defaults to 0.
  4401. @end table
  4402. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  4403. expressions containing the following constants:
  4404. @table @option
  4405. @item x
  4406. @item y
  4407. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  4408. each new frame.
  4409. @item in_w
  4410. @item in_h
  4411. The input width and height.
  4412. @item iw
  4413. @item ih
  4414. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  4415. @item out_w
  4416. @item out_h
  4417. The output (cropped) width and height.
  4418. @item ow
  4419. @item oh
  4420. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  4421. @item a
  4422. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  4423. @item sar
  4424. input sample aspect ratio
  4425. @item dar
  4426. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  4427. @item hsub
  4428. @item vsub
  4429. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  4430. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  4431. @item n
  4432. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  4433. @item pos
  4434. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  4435. @item t
  4436. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  4437. @end table
  4438. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  4439. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  4440. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  4441. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  4442. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  4443. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  4444. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  4445. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  4446. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  4447. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  4448. @subsection Examples
  4449. @itemize
  4450. @item
  4451. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  4452. @example
  4453. crop=100:100:12:34
  4454. @end example
  4455. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  4456. @example
  4457. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  4458. @end example
  4459. @item
  4460. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  4461. @example
  4462. crop=100:100
  4463. @end example
  4464. @item
  4465. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  4466. @example
  4467. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  4468. @end example
  4469. @item
  4470. Crop the input video central square:
  4471. @example
  4472. crop=out_w=in_h
  4473. crop=in_h
  4474. @end example
  4475. @item
  4476. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  4477. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  4478. corner of the input image.
  4479. @example
  4480. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  4481. @end example
  4482. @item
  4483. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  4484. the top and bottom borders
  4485. @example
  4486. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  4487. @end example
  4488. @item
  4489. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  4490. @example
  4491. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  4492. @end example
  4493. @item
  4494. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  4495. @example
  4496. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  4497. @end example
  4498. @item
  4499. Apply trembling effect:
  4500. @example
  4501. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  4502. @end example
  4503. @item
  4504. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  4505. @example
  4506. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  4507. @end example
  4508. @item
  4509. Set x depending on the value of y:
  4510. @example
  4511. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  4512. @end example
  4513. @end itemize
  4514. @subsection Commands
  4515. This filter supports the following commands:
  4516. @table @option
  4517. @item w, out_w
  4518. @item h, out_h
  4519. @item x
  4520. @item y
  4521. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  4522. in the input video.
  4523. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4524. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4525. value.
  4526. @end table
  4527. @section cropdetect
  4528. Auto-detect the crop size.
  4529. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  4530. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  4531. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  4532. It accepts the following parameters:
  4533. @table @option
  4534. @item limit
  4535. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  4536. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  4537. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  4538. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  4539. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  4540. @item round
  4541. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  4542. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  4543. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  4544. encoding to most video codecs.
  4545. @item reset_count, reset
  4546. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  4547. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  4548. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  4549. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  4550. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  4551. playback.
  4552. @end table
  4553. @anchor{curves}
  4554. @section curves
  4555. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  4556. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  4557. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  4558. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  4559. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  4560. the output frame.
  4561. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  4562. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  4563. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  4564. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  4565. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  4566. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  4567. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  4568. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  4569. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  4570. The filter accepts the following options:
  4571. @table @option
  4572. @item preset
  4573. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  4574. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  4575. options takes priority on the preset values.
  4576. Available presets are:
  4577. @table @samp
  4578. @item none
  4579. @item color_negative
  4580. @item cross_process
  4581. @item darker
  4582. @item increase_contrast
  4583. @item lighter
  4584. @item linear_contrast
  4585. @item medium_contrast
  4586. @item negative
  4587. @item strong_contrast
  4588. @item vintage
  4589. @end table
  4590. Default is @code{none}.
  4591. @item master, m
  4592. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  4593. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  4594. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  4595. post-processing LUT.
  4596. @item red, r
  4597. Set the key points for the red component.
  4598. @item green, g
  4599. Set the key points for the green component.
  4600. @item blue, b
  4601. Set the key points for the blue component.
  4602. @item all
  4603. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  4604. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  4605. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  4606. @option{all} setting.
  4607. @item psfile
  4608. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  4609. @item plot
  4610. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  4611. @end table
  4612. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  4613. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  4614. @subsection Examples
  4615. @itemize
  4616. @item
  4617. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  4618. @example
  4619. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  4620. @end example
  4621. @item
  4622. Vintage effect:
  4623. @example
  4624. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  4625. @end example
  4626. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  4627. @table @var
  4628. @item red
  4629. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  4630. @item green
  4631. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  4632. @item blue
  4633. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  4634. @end table
  4635. @item
  4636. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  4637. @example
  4638. curves=preset=vintage
  4639. @end example
  4640. @item
  4641. Or simply:
  4642. @example
  4643. curves=vintage
  4644. @end example
  4645. @item
  4646. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  4647. @example
  4648. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  4649. @end example
  4650. @item
  4651. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  4652. and @command{gnuplot}:
  4653. @example
  4654. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  4655. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  4656. @end example
  4657. @end itemize
  4658. @section datascope
  4659. Video data analysis filter.
  4660. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  4661. The filter accepts the following options:
  4662. @table @option
  4663. @item size, s
  4664. Set output video size.
  4665. @item x
  4666. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  4667. @item y
  4668. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  4669. @item mode
  4670. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  4671. @table @samp
  4672. @item mono
  4673. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  4674. @item color
  4675. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  4676. background.
  4677. @item color2
  4678. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  4679. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  4680. @end table
  4681. @item axis
  4682. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  4683. @item opacity
  4684. Set background opacity.
  4685. @end table
  4686. @section dctdnoiz
  4687. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  4688. This filter is not designed for real time.
  4689. The filter accepts the following options:
  4690. @table @option
  4691. @item sigma, s
  4692. Set the noise sigma constant.
  4693. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  4694. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  4695. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  4696. Default is @code{0}.
  4697. @item overlap
  4698. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  4699. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  4700. risk of various artefacts.
  4701. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  4702. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  4703. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  4704. @item expr, e
  4705. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  4706. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  4707. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  4708. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  4709. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  4710. variable.
  4711. @item n
  4712. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  4713. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  4714. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  4715. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  4716. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  4717. better de-noising.
  4718. @end table
  4719. @subsection Examples
  4720. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  4721. @example
  4722. dctdnoiz=4.5
  4723. @end example
  4724. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  4725. @example
  4726. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  4727. @end example
  4728. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  4729. @example
  4730. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  4731. @end example
  4732. @section deband
  4733. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  4734. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  4735. The filter accepts the following options:
  4736. @table @option
  4737. @item 1thr
  4738. @item 2thr
  4739. @item 3thr
  4740. @item 4thr
  4741. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  4742. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  4743. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  4744. it will be considered as banded.
  4745. @item range, r
  4746. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  4747. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  4748. will be used.
  4749. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  4750. @item direction, d
  4751. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  4752. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  4753. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  4754. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  4755. column.
  4756. @item blur
  4757. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  4758. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  4759. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  4760. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  4761. @end table
  4762. @anchor{decimate}
  4763. @section decimate
  4764. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  4765. The filter accepts the following options:
  4766. @table @option
  4767. @item cycle
  4768. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  4769. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  4770. Default is @code{5}.
  4771. @item dupthresh
  4772. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  4773. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  4774. is @code{1.1}
  4775. @item scthresh
  4776. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  4777. @item blockx
  4778. @item blocky
  4779. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  4780. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  4781. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  4782. @item ppsrc
  4783. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  4784. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  4785. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  4786. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  4787. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  4788. @code{0}.
  4789. @item chroma
  4790. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  4791. @code{1}.
  4792. @end table
  4793. @section deflate
  4794. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  4795. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  4796. only values lower than the pixel.
  4797. It accepts the following options:
  4798. @table @option
  4799. @item threshold0
  4800. @item threshold1
  4801. @item threshold2
  4802. @item threshold3
  4803. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4804. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4805. @end table
  4806. @section dejudder
  4807. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  4808. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  4809. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  4810. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  4811. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  4812. rate video.
  4813. The option available in this filter is:
  4814. @table @option
  4815. @item cycle
  4816. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  4817. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  4818. @table @samp
  4819. @item 4
  4820. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  4821. @item 5
  4822. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  4823. @item 20
  4824. If a mixture of the two.
  4825. @end table
  4826. The default is @samp{4}.
  4827. @end table
  4828. @section delogo
  4829. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  4830. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  4831. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  4832. It accepts the following parameters:
  4833. @table @option
  4834. @item x
  4835. @item y
  4836. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  4837. specified.
  4838. @item w
  4839. @item h
  4840. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  4841. specified.
  4842. @item band, t
  4843. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  4844. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  4845. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  4846. is not recommended.
  4847. @item show
  4848. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  4849. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  4850. The default value is 0.
  4851. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  4852. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  4853. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  4854. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  4855. @end table
  4856. @subsection Examples
  4857. @itemize
  4858. @item
  4859. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  4860. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  4861. @example
  4862. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  4863. @end example
  4864. @end itemize
  4865. @section deshake
  4866. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  4867. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  4868. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  4869. The filter accepts the following options:
  4870. @table @option
  4871. @item x
  4872. @item y
  4873. @item w
  4874. @item h
  4875. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  4876. vectors.
  4877. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  4878. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  4879. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  4880. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  4881. box.
  4882. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  4883. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  4884. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  4885. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  4886. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  4887. Default - search the whole frame.
  4888. @item rx
  4889. @item ry
  4890. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  4891. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  4892. @item edge
  4893. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  4894. frame. Available values are:
  4895. @table @samp
  4896. @item blank, 0
  4897. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  4898. @item original, 1
  4899. Original image at blank locations
  4900. @item clamp, 2
  4901. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  4902. @item mirror, 3
  4903. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  4904. @end table
  4905. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  4906. @item blocksize
  4907. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  4908. default 8.
  4909. @item contrast
  4910. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  4911. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  4912. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  4913. @item search
  4914. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  4915. @table @samp
  4916. @item exhaustive, 0
  4917. Set exhaustive search
  4918. @item less, 1
  4919. Set less exhaustive search.
  4920. @end table
  4921. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  4922. @item filename
  4923. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  4924. specified file.
  4925. @item opencl
  4926. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  4927. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  4928. @end table
  4929. @section detelecine
  4930. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  4931. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  4932. to the telecine filter.
  4933. This filter accepts the following options:
  4934. @table @option
  4935. @item first_field
  4936. @table @samp
  4937. @item top, t
  4938. top field first
  4939. @item bottom, b
  4940. bottom field first
  4941. The default value is @code{top}.
  4942. @end table
  4943. @item pattern
  4944. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  4945. The default value is @code{23}.
  4946. @item start_frame
  4947. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  4948. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  4949. @end table
  4950. @section dilation
  4951. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  4952. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  4953. It accepts the following options:
  4954. @table @option
  4955. @item threshold0
  4956. @item threshold1
  4957. @item threshold2
  4958. @item threshold3
  4959. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4960. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4961. @item coordinates
  4962. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  4963. pixels are used.
  4964. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  4965. 1 2 3
  4966. 4 5
  4967. 6 7 8
  4968. @end table
  4969. @section displace
  4970. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  4971. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  4972. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  4973. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  4974. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  4975. along the y-axis.
  4976. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  4977. displacement map will be used.
  4978. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  4979. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4980. @table @option
  4981. @item edge
  4982. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  4983. Available values are:
  4984. @table @samp
  4985. @item blank
  4986. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  4987. @item smear
  4988. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  4989. @item wrap
  4990. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  4991. @end table
  4992. Default is @samp{smear}.
  4993. @end table
  4994. @subsection Examples
  4995. @itemize
  4996. @item
  4997. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  4998. @example
  4999. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  5000. @end example
  5001. @item
  5002. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  5003. @example
  5004. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  5005. @end example
  5006. @end itemize
  5007. @section drawbox
  5008. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  5009. It accepts the following parameters:
  5010. @table @option
  5011. @item x
  5012. @item y
  5013. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  5014. @item width, w
  5015. @item height, h
  5016. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  5017. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  5018. @item color, c
  5019. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  5020. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  5021. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  5022. video with inverted luma.
  5023. @item thickness, t
  5024. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge. Default value is @code{3}.
  5025. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  5026. @end table
  5027. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  5028. following constants:
  5029. @table @option
  5030. @item dar
  5031. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  5032. @item hsub
  5033. @item vsub
  5034. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5035. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5036. @item in_h, ih
  5037. @item in_w, iw
  5038. The input width and height.
  5039. @item sar
  5040. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5041. @item x
  5042. @item y
  5043. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  5044. @item w
  5045. @item h
  5046. The width and height of the drawn box.
  5047. @item t
  5048. The thickness of the drawn box.
  5049. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  5050. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  5051. @end table
  5052. @subsection Examples
  5053. @itemize
  5054. @item
  5055. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  5056. @example
  5057. drawbox
  5058. @end example
  5059. @item
  5060. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  5061. @example
  5062. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  5063. @end example
  5064. The previous example can be specified as:
  5065. @example
  5066. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  5067. @end example
  5068. @item
  5069. Fill the box with pink color:
  5070. @example
  5071. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=max
  5072. @end example
  5073. @item
  5074. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  5075. @example
  5076. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  5077. @end example
  5078. @end itemize
  5079. @section drawgrid
  5080. Draw a grid on the input image.
  5081. It accepts the following parameters:
  5082. @table @option
  5083. @item x
  5084. @item y
  5085. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  5086. @item width, w
  5087. @item height, h
  5088. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  5089. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  5090. framed. Default to 0.
  5091. @item color, c
  5092. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  5093. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  5094. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  5095. video with inverted luma.
  5096. @item thickness, t
  5097. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  5098. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  5099. @end table
  5100. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  5101. following constants:
  5102. @table @option
  5103. @item dar
  5104. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  5105. @item hsub
  5106. @item vsub
  5107. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5108. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5109. @item in_h, ih
  5110. @item in_w, iw
  5111. The input grid cell width and height.
  5112. @item sar
  5113. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5114. @item x
  5115. @item y
  5116. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  5117. @item w
  5118. @item h
  5119. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  5120. @item t
  5121. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  5122. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  5123. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  5124. @end table
  5125. @subsection Examples
  5126. @itemize
  5127. @item
  5128. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  5129. @example
  5130. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  5131. @end example
  5132. @item
  5133. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  5134. @example
  5135. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  5136. @end example
  5137. @end itemize
  5138. @anchor{drawtext}
  5139. @section drawtext
  5140. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  5141. libfreetype library.
  5142. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  5143. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  5144. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  5145. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  5146. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  5147. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  5148. @subsection Syntax
  5149. It accepts the following parameters:
  5150. @table @option
  5151. @item box
  5152. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  5153. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  5154. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  5155. @item boxborderw
  5156. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  5157. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  5158. @item boxcolor
  5159. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  5160. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5161. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  5162. @item borderw
  5163. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  5164. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  5165. @item bordercolor
  5166. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  5167. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5168. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  5169. @item expansion
  5170. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  5171. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  5172. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  5173. below for details.
  5174. @item fix_bounds
  5175. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  5176. @item fontcolor
  5177. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  5178. the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5179. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  5180. @item fontcolor_expr
  5181. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  5182. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  5183. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  5184. @item font
  5185. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  5186. @item fontfile
  5187. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  5188. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  5189. @item draw
  5190. This option does not exist, please see the timeline system
  5191. @item alpha
  5192. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  5193. be either a number between 0.0 and 1.0
  5194. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} do.
  5195. The default value is 1.
  5196. Please see fontcolor_expr
  5197. @item fontsize
  5198. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  5199. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  5200. @item text_shaping
  5201. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  5202. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  5203. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  5204. By default 1 (if supported).
  5205. @item ft_load_flags
  5206. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  5207. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  5208. a combination of the following values:
  5209. @table @var
  5210. @item default
  5211. @item no_scale
  5212. @item no_hinting
  5213. @item render
  5214. @item no_bitmap
  5215. @item vertical_layout
  5216. @item force_autohint
  5217. @item crop_bitmap
  5218. @item pedantic
  5219. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  5220. @item no_recurse
  5221. @item ignore_transform
  5222. @item monochrome
  5223. @item linear_design
  5224. @item no_autohint
  5225. @end table
  5226. Default value is "default".
  5227. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  5228. libfreetype flags.
  5229. @item shadowcolor
  5230. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  5231. syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5232. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  5233. @item shadowx
  5234. @item shadowy
  5235. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  5236. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  5237. values. The default value for both is "0".
  5238. @item start_number
  5239. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  5240. is "0".
  5241. @item tabsize
  5242. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  5243. Default value is 4.
  5244. @item timecode
  5245. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  5246. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  5247. option must be specified.
  5248. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  5249. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only).
  5250. @item text
  5251. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  5252. encoded characters.
  5253. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  5254. @var{textfile}.
  5255. @item textfile
  5256. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  5257. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  5258. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  5259. parameter @var{text}.
  5260. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  5261. @item reload
  5262. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  5263. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  5264. @item x
  5265. @item y
  5266. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  5267. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  5268. output image.
  5269. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  5270. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  5271. @end table
  5272. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  5273. following constants and functions:
  5274. @table @option
  5275. @item dar
  5276. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  5277. @item hsub
  5278. @item vsub
  5279. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5280. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5281. @item line_h, lh
  5282. the height of each text line
  5283. @item main_h, h, H
  5284. the input height
  5285. @item main_w, w, W
  5286. the input width
  5287. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  5288. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  5289. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  5290. glyphs.
  5291. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  5292. upwards.
  5293. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  5294. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  5295. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  5296. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  5297. upwards.
  5298. @item max_glyph_h
  5299. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  5300. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  5301. @var{descent}.
  5302. @item max_glyph_w
  5303. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  5304. contained in the rendered text
  5305. @item n
  5306. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  5307. @item rand(min, max)
  5308. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  5309. @item sar
  5310. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5311. @item t
  5312. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  5313. @item text_h, th
  5314. the height of the rendered text
  5315. @item text_w, tw
  5316. the width of the rendered text
  5317. @item x
  5318. @item y
  5319. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  5320. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  5321. each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  5322. @end table
  5323. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  5324. @subsection Text expansion
  5325. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  5326. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  5327. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  5328. feature is deprecated.
  5329. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  5330. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  5331. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  5332. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  5333. the second character.
  5334. Sequence of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  5335. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  5336. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  5337. they should be escaped.
  5338. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  5339. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  5340. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  5341. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  5342. problems.
  5343. The following functions are available:
  5344. @table @command
  5345. @item expr, e
  5346. The expression evaluation result.
  5347. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  5348. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  5349. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  5350. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  5351. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  5352. value.
  5353. @item expr_int_format, eif
  5354. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  5355. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  5356. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  5357. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  5358. @code{printf} function.
  5359. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  5360. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  5361. @item gmtime
  5362. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  5363. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  5364. @item localtime
  5365. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  5366. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  5367. @item metadata
  5368. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  5369. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  5370. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  5371. metadata key is not found or empty.
  5372. @item n, frame_num
  5373. The frame number, starting from 0.
  5374. @item pict_type
  5375. A 1 character description of the current picture type.
  5376. @item pts
  5377. The timestamp of the current frame.
  5378. It can take up to three arguments.
  5379. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  5380. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  5381. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  5382. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  5383. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  5384. local time zone time.
  5385. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  5386. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  5387. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  5388. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  5389. @end table
  5390. @subsection Examples
  5391. @itemize
  5392. @item
  5393. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  5394. optional parameters.
  5395. @example
  5396. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  5397. @end example
  5398. @item
  5399. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  5400. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  5401. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  5402. opacity of 20%.
  5403. @example
  5404. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  5405. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  5406. @end example
  5407. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  5408. within the parameter list.
  5409. @item
  5410. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  5411. @example
  5412. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  5413. @end example
  5414. @item
  5415. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  5416. @example
  5417. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  5418. @end example
  5419. @item
  5420. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  5421. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  5422. with no newlines.
  5423. @example
  5424. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  5425. @end example
  5426. @item
  5427. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  5428. @example
  5429. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  5430. @end example
  5431. @item
  5432. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  5433. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  5434. @example
  5435. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  5436. @end example
  5437. @item
  5438. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  5439. @example
  5440. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  5441. @end example
  5442. @item
  5443. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  5444. @example
  5445. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  5446. @end example
  5447. @item
  5448. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  5449. @example
  5450. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  5451. @end example
  5452. @item
  5453. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  5454. @example
  5455. #!/bin/sh
  5456. DS=1.0 # display start
  5457. DE=10.0 # display end
  5458. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  5459. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  5460. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  5461. @end example
  5462. @end itemize
  5463. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  5464. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  5465. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  5466. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  5467. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  5468. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  5469. @section edgedetect
  5470. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  5471. The filter accepts the following options:
  5472. @table @option
  5473. @item low
  5474. @item high
  5475. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  5476. algorithm.
  5477. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  5478. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  5479. by the low threshold.
  5480. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  5481. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  5482. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  5483. is @code{50/255}.
  5484. @item mode
  5485. Define the drawing mode.
  5486. @table @samp
  5487. @item wires
  5488. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  5489. @item colormix
  5490. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  5491. @end table
  5492. Default value is @var{wires}.
  5493. @end table
  5494. @subsection Examples
  5495. @itemize
  5496. @item
  5497. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  5498. @example
  5499. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  5500. @end example
  5501. @item
  5502. Painting effect without thresholding:
  5503. @example
  5504. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  5505. @end example
  5506. @end itemize
  5507. @section eq
  5508. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  5509. The filter accepts the following options:
  5510. @table @option
  5511. @item contrast
  5512. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  5513. @code{-2.0} to @code{2.0}. The default value is "1".
  5514. @item brightness
  5515. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  5516. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  5517. @item saturation
  5518. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  5519. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  5520. @item gamma
  5521. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  5522. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5523. @item gamma_r
  5524. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  5525. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5526. @item gamma_g
  5527. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  5528. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5529. @item gamma_b
  5530. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  5531. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5532. @item gamma_weight
  5533. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  5534. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  5535. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  5536. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  5537. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  5538. full strength. Default is "1".
  5539. @item eval
  5540. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  5541. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  5542. It accepts the following values:
  5543. @table @samp
  5544. @item init
  5545. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  5546. when a command is processed
  5547. @item frame
  5548. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  5549. @end table
  5550. Default value is @samp{init}.
  5551. @end table
  5552. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  5553. @table @option
  5554. @item n
  5555. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  5556. @item pos
  5557. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  5558. unspecified
  5559. @item r
  5560. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  5561. @item t
  5562. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  5563. @end table
  5564. @subsection Commands
  5565. The filter supports the following commands:
  5566. @table @option
  5567. @item contrast
  5568. Set the contrast expression.
  5569. @item brightness
  5570. Set the brightness expression.
  5571. @item saturation
  5572. Set the saturation expression.
  5573. @item gamma
  5574. Set the gamma expression.
  5575. @item gamma_r
  5576. Set the gamma_r expression.
  5577. @item gamma_g
  5578. Set gamma_g expression.
  5579. @item gamma_b
  5580. Set gamma_b expression.
  5581. @item gamma_weight
  5582. Set gamma_weight expression.
  5583. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5584. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5585. value.
  5586. @end table
  5587. @section erosion
  5588. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  5589. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  5590. It accepts the following options:
  5591. @table @option
  5592. @item threshold0
  5593. @item threshold1
  5594. @item threshold2
  5595. @item threshold3
  5596. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  5597. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  5598. @item coordinates
  5599. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  5600. pixels are used.
  5601. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  5602. 1 2 3
  5603. 4 5
  5604. 6 7 8
  5605. @end table
  5606. @section extractplanes
  5607. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  5608. separate grayscale video streams.
  5609. The filter accepts the following option:
  5610. @table @option
  5611. @item planes
  5612. Set plane(s) to extract.
  5613. Available values for planes are:
  5614. @table @samp
  5615. @item y
  5616. @item u
  5617. @item v
  5618. @item a
  5619. @item r
  5620. @item g
  5621. @item b
  5622. @end table
  5623. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  5624. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  5625. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  5626. @end table
  5627. @subsection Examples
  5628. @itemize
  5629. @item
  5630. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  5631. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  5632. @example
  5633. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  5634. @end example
  5635. @end itemize
  5636. @section elbg
  5637. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  5638. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  5639. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  5640. of distinct output colors.
  5641. This filter accepts the following options.
  5642. @table @option
  5643. @item codebook_length, l
  5644. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  5645. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  5646. @item nb_steps, n
  5647. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  5648. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  5649. computation time. Default value is 1.
  5650. @item seed, s
  5651. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  5652. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  5653. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  5654. @item pal8
  5655. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  5656. length greater than 256.
  5657. @end table
  5658. @section fade
  5659. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  5660. It accepts the following parameters:
  5661. @table @option
  5662. @item type, t
  5663. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  5664. effect.
  5665. Default is @code{in}.
  5666. @item start_frame, s
  5667. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  5668. effect at. Default is 0.
  5669. @item nb_frames, n
  5670. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  5671. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  5672. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  5673. selected @option{color}.
  5674. Default is 25.
  5675. @item alpha
  5676. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  5677. Default value is 0.
  5678. @item start_time, st
  5679. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  5680. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  5681. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  5682. @item duration, d
  5683. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  5684. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  5685. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  5686. selected @option{color}.
  5687. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  5688. (nb_frames is used by default).
  5689. @item color, c
  5690. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  5691. @end table
  5692. @subsection Examples
  5693. @itemize
  5694. @item
  5695. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  5696. @example
  5697. fade=in:0:30
  5698. @end example
  5699. The command above is equivalent to:
  5700. @example
  5701. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  5702. @end example
  5703. @item
  5704. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  5705. @example
  5706. fade=out:155:45
  5707. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  5708. @end example
  5709. @item
  5710. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  5711. @example
  5712. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  5713. @end example
  5714. @item
  5715. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  5716. @example
  5717. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  5718. @end example
  5719. @item
  5720. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  5721. @example
  5722. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  5723. @end example
  5724. @item
  5725. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  5726. @example
  5727. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  5728. @end example
  5729. @end itemize
  5730. @section fftfilt
  5731. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  5732. @table @option
  5733. @item dc_Y
  5734. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  5735. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  5736. value is set to @code{0}.
  5737. @item dc_U
  5738. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  5739. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5740. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5741. @item dc_V
  5742. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  5743. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5744. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5745. @item weight_Y
  5746. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  5747. @item weight_U
  5748. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  5749. @item weight_V
  5750. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  5751. The filter accepts the following variables:
  5752. @item X
  5753. @item Y
  5754. The coordinates of the current sample.
  5755. @item W
  5756. @item H
  5757. The width and height of the image.
  5758. @end table
  5759. @subsection Examples
  5760. @itemize
  5761. @item
  5762. High-pass:
  5763. @example
  5764. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5765. @end example
  5766. @item
  5767. Low-pass:
  5768. @example
  5769. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  5770. @end example
  5771. @item
  5772. Sharpen:
  5773. @example
  5774. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5775. @end example
  5776. @item
  5777. Blur:
  5778. @example
  5779. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  5780. @end example
  5781. @end itemize
  5782. @section field
  5783. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  5784. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  5785. non-interlaced.
  5786. The filter accepts the following options:
  5787. @table @option
  5788. @item type
  5789. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  5790. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  5791. @code{bottom}).
  5792. @end table
  5793. @section fieldhint
  5794. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  5795. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  5796. @table @option
  5797. @item hint
  5798. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  5799. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  5800. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  5801. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  5802. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  5803. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  5804. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  5805. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  5806. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  5807. it will be marked same as input frame.
  5808. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  5809. @item mode
  5810. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  5811. @end table
  5812. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  5813. @example
  5814. 0,0 - # first frame
  5815. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  5816. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  5817. 1,0 -
  5818. 0,0 -
  5819. 0,0 -
  5820. 1,0 -
  5821. 1,0 -
  5822. 1,0 -
  5823. 0,0 -
  5824. 0,0 -
  5825. 1,0 -
  5826. 1,0 -
  5827. 1,0 -
  5828. 0,0 -
  5829. @end example
  5830. @section fieldmatch
  5831. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  5832. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  5833. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  5834. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  5835. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  5836. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  5837. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  5838. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  5839. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  5840. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  5841. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  5842. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  5843. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  5844. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  5845. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  5846. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  5847. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  5848. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  5849. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  5850. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  5851. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  5852. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  5853. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  5854. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  5855. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  5856. The filter accepts the following options:
  5857. @table @option
  5858. @item order
  5859. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  5860. @table @samp
  5861. @item auto
  5862. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  5863. @item bff
  5864. Assume bottom field first.
  5865. @item tff
  5866. Assume top field first.
  5867. @end table
  5868. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  5869. stream.
  5870. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5871. @item mode
  5872. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  5873. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  5874. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  5875. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  5876. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  5877. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  5878. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  5879. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  5880. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  5881. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  5882. Available values are:
  5883. @table @samp
  5884. @item pc
  5885. 2-way matching (p/c)
  5886. @item pc_n
  5887. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  5888. @item pc_u
  5889. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  5890. @item pc_n_ub
  5891. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  5892. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  5893. @item pcn
  5894. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  5895. @item pcn_ub
  5896. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  5897. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  5898. @end table
  5899. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  5900. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  5901. @var{top}).
  5902. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  5903. the slowest.
  5904. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  5905. @item ppsrc
  5906. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  5907. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  5908. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  5909. VFM/TFM.
  5910. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  5911. @item field
  5912. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  5913. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  5914. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  5915. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  5916. @table @samp
  5917. @item auto
  5918. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  5919. @item bottom
  5920. Match from the bottom field.
  5921. @item top
  5922. Match from the top field.
  5923. @end table
  5924. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5925. @item mchroma
  5926. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  5927. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  5928. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  5929. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  5930. the cost of some accuracy.
  5931. Default value is @code{1}.
  5932. @item y0
  5933. @item y1
  5934. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  5935. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  5936. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  5937. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  5938. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  5939. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  5940. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  5941. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  5942. @item scthresh
  5943. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  5944. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  5945. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  5946. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  5947. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  5948. @item combmatch
  5949. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  5950. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  5951. final match. Available values are:
  5952. @table @samp
  5953. @item none
  5954. No final matching based on combed scores.
  5955. @item sc
  5956. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  5957. @item full
  5958. Use combed scores all the time.
  5959. @end table
  5960. Default is @var{sc}.
  5961. @item combdbg
  5962. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  5963. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  5964. Available values are:
  5965. @table @samp
  5966. @item none
  5967. No forced calculation.
  5968. @item pcn
  5969. Force p/c/n calculations.
  5970. @item pcnub
  5971. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  5972. @end table
  5973. Default value is @var{none}.
  5974. @item cthresh
  5975. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  5976. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  5977. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  5978. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  5979. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  5980. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  5981. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  5982. Default value is @code{9}.
  5983. @item chroma
  5984. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  5985. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  5986. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  5987. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  5988. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  5989. Default value is @code{0}.
  5990. @item blockx
  5991. @item blocky
  5992. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  5993. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  5994. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  5995. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  5996. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  5997. to 512.
  5998. Default value is @code{16}.
  5999. @item combpel
  6000. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  6001. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  6002. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  6003. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  6004. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  6005. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  6006. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  6007. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  6008. Default value is @code{80}.
  6009. @end table
  6010. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  6011. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  6012. @subsubsection p/c/n
  6013. We assume the following telecined stream:
  6014. @example
  6015. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  6016. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  6017. @end example
  6018. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  6019. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  6020. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  6021. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  6022. @example
  6023. Input stream:
  6024. T 1 2 2 3 4
  6025. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  6026. Matches: c c n n c
  6027. Output stream:
  6028. T 1 2 3 4 4
  6029. B 1 2 3 4 4
  6030. @end example
  6031. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  6032. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  6033. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  6034. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  6035. looks like this:
  6036. @example
  6037. Input stream:
  6038. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  6039. B 1 2 3 4 4
  6040. Matches: c c p p c
  6041. Output stream:
  6042. T 1 2 2 3 4
  6043. B 1 2 2 3 4
  6044. @end example
  6045. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  6046. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  6047. @itemize
  6048. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  6049. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  6050. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  6051. @end itemize
  6052. @subsubsection u/b
  6053. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  6054. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  6055. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  6056. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  6057. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  6058. @example
  6059. Match: c p n b u
  6060. x x x x x
  6061. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  6062. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  6063. x x x x x
  6064. Output frames:
  6065. 2 1 2 2 2
  6066. 2 2 2 1 3
  6067. @end example
  6068. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  6069. @example
  6070. Match: c p n b u
  6071. x x x x x
  6072. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  6073. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  6074. x x x x x
  6075. Output frames:
  6076. 2 2 2 1 2
  6077. 2 1 3 2 2
  6078. @end example
  6079. @subsection Examples
  6080. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  6081. @example
  6082. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  6083. @end example
  6084. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  6085. @example
  6086. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  6087. @end example
  6088. @section fieldorder
  6089. Transform the field order of the input video.
  6090. It accepts the following parameters:
  6091. @table @option
  6092. @item order
  6093. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  6094. for bottom field first.
  6095. @end table
  6096. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  6097. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  6098. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  6099. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  6100. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  6101. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  6102. not alter the incoming video.
  6103. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  6104. which is bottom field first.
  6105. For example:
  6106. @example
  6107. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  6108. @end example
  6109. @section fifo, afifo
  6110. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  6111. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  6112. framework.
  6113. It does not take parameters.
  6114. @section find_rect
  6115. Find a rectangular object
  6116. It accepts the following options:
  6117. @table @option
  6118. @item object
  6119. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  6120. @item threshold
  6121. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  6122. @item mipmaps
  6123. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  6124. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  6125. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  6126. @end table
  6127. @subsection Examples
  6128. @itemize
  6129. @item
  6130. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6131. @example
  6132. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6133. @end example
  6134. @end itemize
  6135. @section cover_rect
  6136. Cover a rectangular object
  6137. It accepts the following options:
  6138. @table @option
  6139. @item cover
  6140. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6141. @item mode
  6142. Set covering mode.
  6143. It accepts the following values:
  6144. @table @samp
  6145. @item cover
  6146. cover it by the supplied image
  6147. @item blur
  6148. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6149. @end table
  6150. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6151. @end table
  6152. @subsection Examples
  6153. @itemize
  6154. @item
  6155. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6156. @example
  6157. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6158. @end example
  6159. @end itemize
  6160. @anchor{format}
  6161. @section format
  6162. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  6163. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  6164. the next filter.
  6165. It accepts the following parameters:
  6166. @table @option
  6167. @item pix_fmts
  6168. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  6169. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  6170. @end table
  6171. @subsection Examples
  6172. @itemize
  6173. @item
  6174. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  6175. @example
  6176. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  6177. @end example
  6178. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  6179. @example
  6180. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  6181. @end example
  6182. @end itemize
  6183. @anchor{fps}
  6184. @section fps
  6185. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  6186. frames as necessary.
  6187. It accepts the following parameters:
  6188. @table @option
  6189. @item fps
  6190. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  6191. @item round
  6192. Rounding method.
  6193. Possible values are:
  6194. @table @option
  6195. @item zero
  6196. zero round towards 0
  6197. @item inf
  6198. round away from 0
  6199. @item down
  6200. round towards -infinity
  6201. @item up
  6202. round towards +infinity
  6203. @item near
  6204. round to nearest
  6205. @end table
  6206. The default is @code{near}.
  6207. @item start_time
  6208. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  6209. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  6210. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  6211. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  6212. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  6213. frames with a negative PTS.
  6214. @end table
  6215. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  6216. @var{fps}[:@var{round}].
  6217. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  6218. @subsection Examples
  6219. @itemize
  6220. @item
  6221. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  6222. @example
  6223. fps=fps=25
  6224. @end example
  6225. @item
  6226. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  6227. @example
  6228. fps=fps=film:round=near
  6229. @end example
  6230. @end itemize
  6231. @section framepack
  6232. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  6233. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  6234. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  6235. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  6236. @ref{fps} filters.
  6237. It accepts the following parameters:
  6238. @table @option
  6239. @item format
  6240. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  6241. @table @option
  6242. @item sbs
  6243. The views are next to each other (default).
  6244. @item tab
  6245. The views are on top of each other.
  6246. @item lines
  6247. The views are packed by line.
  6248. @item columns
  6249. The views are packed by column.
  6250. @item frameseq
  6251. The views are temporally interleaved.
  6252. @end table
  6253. @end table
  6254. Some examples:
  6255. @example
  6256. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  6257. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  6258. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  6259. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  6260. @end example
  6261. @section framerate
  6262. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  6263. frames.
  6264. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  6265. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  6266. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  6267. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6268. @table @option
  6269. @item fps
  6270. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  6271. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  6272. @item interp_start
  6273. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  6274. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  6275. the default is @code{15}.
  6276. @item interp_end
  6277. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  6278. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  6279. the default is @code{240}.
  6280. @item scene
  6281. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  6282. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  6283. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  6284. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  6285. The default is @code{7}.
  6286. @item flags
  6287. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  6288. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  6289. @table @option
  6290. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  6291. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  6292. This flag is enabled by default.
  6293. @end table
  6294. @end table
  6295. @section framestep
  6296. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  6297. This filter accepts the following option:
  6298. @table @option
  6299. @item step
  6300. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  6301. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  6302. @end table
  6303. @anchor{frei0r}
  6304. @section frei0r
  6305. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  6306. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  6307. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  6308. It accepts the following parameters:
  6309. @table @option
  6310. @item filter_name
  6311. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  6312. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  6313. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREIOR_PATH}.
  6314. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  6315. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  6316. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  6317. @item filter_params
  6318. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  6319. @end table
  6320. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  6321. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  6322. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  6323. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or by a color description specified in the "Color"
  6324. section in the ffmpeg-utils manual), a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  6325. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  6326. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  6327. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  6328. @subsection Examples
  6329. @itemize
  6330. @item
  6331. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  6332. @example
  6333. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  6334. @end example
  6335. @item
  6336. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  6337. @example
  6338. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  6339. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  6340. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  6341. @end example
  6342. @item
  6343. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  6344. positions:
  6345. @example
  6346. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  6347. @end example
  6348. @end itemize
  6349. For more information, see
  6350. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  6351. @section fspp
  6352. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  6353. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  6354. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  6355. This allows for much higher speed.
  6356. The filter accepts the following options:
  6357. @table @option
  6358. @item quality
  6359. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  6360. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  6361. @item qp
  6362. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  6363. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  6364. @item strength
  6365. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  6366. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  6367. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  6368. @item use_bframe_qp
  6369. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  6370. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  6371. @code{0} (not enabled).
  6372. @end table
  6373. @section gblur
  6374. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  6375. The filter accepts the following options:
  6376. @table @option
  6377. @item sigma
  6378. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  6379. @item steps
  6380. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Defauls is @code{1}.
  6381. @item planes
  6382. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  6383. @item sigmaV
  6384. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  6385. Default is @code{-1}.
  6386. @end table
  6387. @section geq
  6388. The filter accepts the following options:
  6389. @table @option
  6390. @item lum_expr, lum
  6391. Set the luminance expression.
  6392. @item cb_expr, cb
  6393. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  6394. @item cr_expr, cr
  6395. Set the chrominance red expression.
  6396. @item alpha_expr, a
  6397. Set the alpha expression.
  6398. @item red_expr, r
  6399. Set the red expression.
  6400. @item green_expr, g
  6401. Set the green expression.
  6402. @item blue_expr, b
  6403. Set the blue expression.
  6404. @end table
  6405. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  6406. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  6407. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  6408. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  6409. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  6410. colorspace.
  6411. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  6412. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  6413. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  6414. to the luminance expression.
  6415. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  6416. @table @option
  6417. @item N
  6418. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  6419. @item X
  6420. @item Y
  6421. The coordinates of the current sample.
  6422. @item W
  6423. @item H
  6424. The width and height of the image.
  6425. @item SW
  6426. @item SH
  6427. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  6428. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  6429. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  6430. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  6431. @item T
  6432. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  6433. @item p(x, y)
  6434. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  6435. plane.
  6436. @item lum(x, y)
  6437. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  6438. plane.
  6439. @item cb(x, y)
  6440. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6441. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6442. @item cr(x, y)
  6443. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6444. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6445. @item r(x, y)
  6446. @item g(x, y)
  6447. @item b(x, y)
  6448. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6449. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  6450. @item alpha(x, y)
  6451. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  6452. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6453. @end table
  6454. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  6455. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  6456. @subsection Examples
  6457. @itemize
  6458. @item
  6459. Flip the image horizontally:
  6460. @example
  6461. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  6462. @end example
  6463. @item
  6464. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  6465. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  6466. @example
  6467. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  6468. @end example
  6469. @item
  6470. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  6471. @example
  6472. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  6473. @end example
  6474. @item
  6475. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  6476. @example
  6477. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  6478. @end example
  6479. @item
  6480. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  6481. @example
  6482. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  6483. @end example
  6484. @item
  6485. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  6486. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  6487. @example
  6488. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  6489. @end example
  6490. @end itemize
  6491. @section gradfun
  6492. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  6493. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  6494. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  6495. dither them.
  6496. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  6497. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  6498. bring back the bands.
  6499. It accepts the following parameters:
  6500. @table @option
  6501. @item strength
  6502. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  6503. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  6504. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  6505. valid range.
  6506. @item radius
  6507. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  6508. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  6509. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  6510. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  6511. @end table
  6512. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  6513. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  6514. @subsection Examples
  6515. @itemize
  6516. @item
  6517. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  6518. @example
  6519. gradfun=3.5:8
  6520. @end example
  6521. @item
  6522. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  6523. value):
  6524. @example
  6525. gradfun=radius=8
  6526. @end example
  6527. @end itemize
  6528. @anchor{haldclut}
  6529. @section haldclut
  6530. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  6531. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  6532. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  6533. The filter accepts the following options:
  6534. @table @option
  6535. @item shortest
  6536. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  6537. @item repeatlast
  6538. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  6539. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  6540. Default is @code{1}.
  6541. @end table
  6542. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  6543. filters share the same internals).
  6544. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  6545. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  6546. @subsection Workflow examples
  6547. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  6548. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  6549. @example
  6550. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  6551. @end example
  6552. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  6553. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  6554. @example
  6555. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  6556. @end example
  6557. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  6558. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  6559. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  6560. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  6561. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  6562. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  6563. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  6564. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  6565. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  6566. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  6567. @code{haldclut} filter:
  6568. @example
  6569. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  6570. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  6571. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  6572. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  6573. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  6574. @end example
  6575. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  6576. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  6577. the color changes.
  6578. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  6579. @example
  6580. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  6581. @end example
  6582. @section hflip
  6583. Flip the input video horizontally.
  6584. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  6585. @example
  6586. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  6587. @end example
  6588. @section histeq
  6589. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  6590. per-frame basis.
  6591. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  6592. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  6593. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  6594. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  6595. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  6596. video.
  6597. The filter accepts the following options:
  6598. @table @option
  6599. @item strength
  6600. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  6601. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  6602. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  6603. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  6604. @item intensity
  6605. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  6606. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  6607. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  6608. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  6609. @item antibanding
  6610. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  6611. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  6612. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  6613. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  6614. @end table
  6615. @section histogram
  6616. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  6617. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  6618. distribution in an image.
  6619. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  6620. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  6621. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  6622. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  6623. The filter accepts the following options:
  6624. @table @option
  6625. @item level_height
  6626. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  6627. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  6628. @item scale_height
  6629. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  6630. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  6631. @item display_mode
  6632. Set display mode.
  6633. It accepts the following values:
  6634. @table @samp
  6635. @item parade
  6636. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  6637. @item overlay
  6638. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  6639. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  6640. over one another.
  6641. @end table
  6642. Default is @code{parade}.
  6643. @item levels_mode
  6644. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  6645. Default is @code{linear}.
  6646. @item components
  6647. Set what color components to display.
  6648. Default is @code{7}.
  6649. @item fgopacity
  6650. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  6651. @item bgopacity
  6652. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  6653. @end table
  6654. @subsection Examples
  6655. @itemize
  6656. @item
  6657. Calculate and draw histogram:
  6658. @example
  6659. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  6660. @end example
  6661. @end itemize
  6662. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  6663. @section hqdn3d
  6664. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  6665. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  6666. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  6667. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6668. @table @option
  6669. @item luma_spatial
  6670. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  6671. It defaults to 4.0.
  6672. @item chroma_spatial
  6673. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  6674. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6675. @item luma_tmp
  6676. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6677. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6678. @item chroma_tmp
  6679. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6680. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  6681. @end table
  6682. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  6683. @section hwupload_cuda
  6684. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  6685. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6686. @table @option
  6687. @item device
  6688. The number of the CUDA device to use
  6689. @end table
  6690. @section hqx
  6691. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  6692. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  6693. It accepts the following option:
  6694. @table @option
  6695. @item n
  6696. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  6697. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  6698. Default is @code{3}.
  6699. @end table
  6700. @section hstack
  6701. Stack input videos horizontally.
  6702. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  6703. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  6704. to create same output.
  6705. The filter accept the following option:
  6706. @table @option
  6707. @item inputs
  6708. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  6709. @item shortest
  6710. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  6711. terminates. Default value is 0.
  6712. @end table
  6713. @section hue
  6714. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  6715. It accepts the following parameters:
  6716. @table @option
  6717. @item h
  6718. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  6719. and defaults to "0".
  6720. @item s
  6721. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6722. defaults to "1".
  6723. @item H
  6724. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  6725. expression, and defaults to "0".
  6726. @item b
  6727. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6728. defaults to "0".
  6729. @end table
  6730. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  6731. specified at the same time.
  6732. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  6733. expressions containing the following constants:
  6734. @table @option
  6735. @item n
  6736. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  6737. @item pts
  6738. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  6739. @item r
  6740. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  6741. @item t
  6742. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  6743. @item tb
  6744. time base of the input video
  6745. @end table
  6746. @subsection Examples
  6747. @itemize
  6748. @item
  6749. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  6750. @example
  6751. hue=h=90:s=1
  6752. @end example
  6753. @item
  6754. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  6755. @example
  6756. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  6757. @end example
  6758. @item
  6759. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  6760. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  6761. @example
  6762. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  6763. @end example
  6764. @item
  6765. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  6766. @example
  6767. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  6768. @end example
  6769. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  6770. @example
  6771. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  6772. @end example
  6773. @item
  6774. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  6775. @example
  6776. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  6777. @end example
  6778. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  6779. @example
  6780. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  6781. @end example
  6782. @end itemize
  6783. @subsection Commands
  6784. This filter supports the following commands:
  6785. @table @option
  6786. @item b
  6787. @item s
  6788. @item h
  6789. @item H
  6790. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  6791. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6792. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6793. value.
  6794. @end table
  6795. @section hysteresis
  6796. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  6797. This allows to build more robust edge masks.
  6798. This filter accepts the following options:
  6799. @table @option
  6800. @item planes
  6801. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  6802. copied from first stream.
  6803. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  6804. @item threshold
  6805. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  6806. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  6807. By default value is 0.
  6808. @end table
  6809. @section idet
  6810. Detect video interlacing type.
  6811. This filter tries to detect if the input frames as interlaced, progressive,
  6812. top or bottom field first. It will also try and detect fields that are
  6813. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  6814. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  6815. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  6816. The filter will log these metadata values:
  6817. @table @option
  6818. @item single.current_frame
  6819. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  6820. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6821. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6822. @item single.tff
  6823. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  6824. @item multiple.tff
  6825. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6826. @item single.bff
  6827. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  6828. @item multiple.current_frame
  6829. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  6830. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6831. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6832. @item multiple.bff
  6833. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6834. @item single.progressive
  6835. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  6836. @item multiple.progressive
  6837. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  6838. @item single.undetermined
  6839. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  6840. @item multiple.undetermined
  6841. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  6842. @item repeated.current_frame
  6843. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  6844. @item repeated.neither
  6845. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  6846. @item repeated.top
  6847. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  6848. @item repeated.bottom
  6849. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  6850. @end table
  6851. The filter accepts the following options:
  6852. @table @option
  6853. @item intl_thres
  6854. Set interlacing threshold.
  6855. @item prog_thres
  6856. Set progressive threshold.
  6857. @item rep_thres
  6858. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  6859. @item half_life
  6860. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  6861. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to it's
  6862. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  6863. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  6864. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  6865. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  6866. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  6867. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  6868. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  6869. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  6870. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  6871. @end table
  6872. @section il
  6873. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  6874. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  6875. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  6876. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  6877. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  6878. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  6879. The filter accepts the following options:
  6880. @table @option
  6881. @item luma_mode, l
  6882. @item chroma_mode, c
  6883. @item alpha_mode, a
  6884. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  6885. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  6886. @table @samp
  6887. @item none
  6888. Do nothing.
  6889. @item deinterleave, d
  6890. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  6891. @item interleave, i
  6892. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  6893. @end table
  6894. Default value is @code{none}.
  6895. @item luma_swap, ls
  6896. @item chroma_swap, cs
  6897. @item alpha_swap, as
  6898. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  6899. @end table
  6900. @section inflate
  6901. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  6902. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6903. only values higher than the pixel.
  6904. It accepts the following options:
  6905. @table @option
  6906. @item threshold0
  6907. @item threshold1
  6908. @item threshold2
  6909. @item threshold3
  6910. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6911. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6912. @end table
  6913. @section interlace
  6914. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  6915. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  6916. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  6917. @example
  6918. Original Original New Frame
  6919. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  6920. ========== =========== ==================
  6921. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  6922. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  6923. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  6924. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  6925. ... ... ...
  6926. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  6927. @end example
  6928. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6929. @table @option
  6930. @item scan
  6931. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  6932. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  6933. @item lowpass
  6934. Enable (default) or disable the vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter
  6935. interlacing and reduce moire patterns.
  6936. @end table
  6937. @section kerndeint
  6938. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  6939. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  6940. progressive frames.
  6941. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  6942. @table @option
  6943. @item thresh
  6944. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  6945. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  6946. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  6947. applying the process on every pixels.
  6948. @item map
  6949. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  6950. Default is 0.
  6951. @item order
  6952. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  6953. 0. Default is 0.
  6954. @item sharp
  6955. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6956. @item twoway
  6957. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6958. @end table
  6959. @subsection Examples
  6960. @itemize
  6961. @item
  6962. Apply default values:
  6963. @example
  6964. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  6965. @end example
  6966. @item
  6967. Enable additional sharpening:
  6968. @example
  6969. kerndeint=sharp=1
  6970. @end example
  6971. @item
  6972. Paint processed pixels in white:
  6973. @example
  6974. kerndeint=map=1
  6975. @end example
  6976. @end itemize
  6977. @section lenscorrection
  6978. Correct radial lens distortion
  6979. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  6980. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  6981. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  6982. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  6983. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  6984. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  6985. Digikam from the KDE project.
  6986. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  6987. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  6988. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  6989. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  6990. be applied before or after lens correction.
  6991. @subsection Options
  6992. The filter accepts the following options:
  6993. @table @option
  6994. @item cx
  6995. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  6996. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  6997. width.
  6998. @item cy
  6999. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  7000. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  7001. height.
  7002. @item k1
  7003. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  7004. @item k2
  7005. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  7006. @end table
  7007. The formula that generates the correction is:
  7008. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  7009. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  7010. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  7011. @section loop
  7012. Loop video frames.
  7013. The filter accepts the following options:
  7014. @table @option
  7015. @item loop
  7016. Set the number of loops.
  7017. @item size
  7018. Set maximal size in number of frames.
  7019. @item start
  7020. Set first frame of loop.
  7021. @end table
  7022. @anchor{lut3d}
  7023. @section lut3d
  7024. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  7025. The filter accepts the following options:
  7026. @table @option
  7027. @item file
  7028. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  7029. Currently supported formats:
  7030. @table @samp
  7031. @item 3dl
  7032. AfterEffects
  7033. @item cube
  7034. Iridas
  7035. @item dat
  7036. DaVinci
  7037. @item m3d
  7038. Pandora
  7039. @end table
  7040. @item interp
  7041. Select interpolation mode.
  7042. Available values are:
  7043. @table @samp
  7044. @item nearest
  7045. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  7046. @item trilinear
  7047. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  7048. @item tetrahedral
  7049. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  7050. @end table
  7051. @end table
  7052. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  7053. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  7054. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  7055. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  7056. to an RGB input video.
  7057. These filters accept the following parameters:
  7058. @table @option
  7059. @item c0
  7060. set first pixel component expression
  7061. @item c1
  7062. set second pixel component expression
  7063. @item c2
  7064. set third pixel component expression
  7065. @item c3
  7066. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  7067. @item r
  7068. set red component expression
  7069. @item g
  7070. set green component expression
  7071. @item b
  7072. set blue component expression
  7073. @item a
  7074. alpha component expression
  7075. @item y
  7076. set Y/luminance component expression
  7077. @item u
  7078. set U/Cb component expression
  7079. @item v
  7080. set V/Cr component expression
  7081. @end table
  7082. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  7083. the corresponding pixel component values.
  7084. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  7085. format in input.
  7086. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  7087. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  7088. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  7089. @table @option
  7090. @item w
  7091. @item h
  7092. The input width and height.
  7093. @item val
  7094. The input value for the pixel component.
  7095. @item clipval
  7096. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  7097. @item maxval
  7098. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  7099. @item minval
  7100. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  7101. @item negval
  7102. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  7103. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  7104. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  7105. @item clip(val)
  7106. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  7107. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  7108. @item gammaval(gamma)
  7109. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  7110. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  7111. expression
  7112. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  7113. @end table
  7114. All expressions default to "val".
  7115. @subsection Examples
  7116. @itemize
  7117. @item
  7118. Negate input video:
  7119. @example
  7120. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  7121. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  7122. @end example
  7123. The above is the same as:
  7124. @example
  7125. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  7126. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  7127. @end example
  7128. @item
  7129. Negate luminance:
  7130. @example
  7131. lutyuv=y=negval
  7132. @end example
  7133. @item
  7134. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  7135. @example
  7136. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  7137. @end example
  7138. @item
  7139. Apply a luma burning effect:
  7140. @example
  7141. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  7142. @end example
  7143. @item
  7144. Remove green and blue components:
  7145. @example
  7146. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  7147. @end example
  7148. @item
  7149. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  7150. @example
  7151. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  7152. @end example
  7153. @item
  7154. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  7155. @example
  7156. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  7157. @end example
  7158. @item
  7159. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  7160. @example
  7161. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  7162. @end example
  7163. @item
  7164. Technicolor like effect:
  7165. @example
  7166. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  7167. @end example
  7168. @end itemize
  7169. @section lut2
  7170. Compute and apply a lookup table from two video inputs.
  7171. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  7172. @table @option
  7173. @item c0
  7174. set first pixel component expression
  7175. @item c1
  7176. set second pixel component expression
  7177. @item c2
  7178. set third pixel component expression
  7179. @item c3
  7180. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  7181. @end table
  7182. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  7183. the corresponding pixel component values.
  7184. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  7185. format in inputs.
  7186. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  7187. @table @option
  7188. @item w
  7189. @item h
  7190. The input width and height.
  7191. @item x
  7192. The first input value for the pixel component.
  7193. @item y
  7194. The second input value for the pixel component.
  7195. @item bdx
  7196. The first input video bit depth.
  7197. @item bdy
  7198. The second input video bit depth.
  7199. @end table
  7200. All expressions default to "x".
  7201. @section maskedclamp
  7202. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  7203. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  7204. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  7205. This filter accepts the following options:
  7206. @table @option
  7207. @item undershoot
  7208. Default value is @code{0}.
  7209. @item overshoot
  7210. Default value is @code{0}.
  7211. @item planes
  7212. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  7213. copied from first stream.
  7214. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  7215. @end table
  7216. @section maskedmerge
  7217. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  7218. weights in the third input stream.
  7219. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  7220. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  7221. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  7222. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  7223. input stream's pixel components.
  7224. This filter accepts the following options:
  7225. @table @option
  7226. @item planes
  7227. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  7228. copied from first stream.
  7229. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  7230. @end table
  7231. @section mcdeint
  7232. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  7233. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  7234. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  7235. This filter accepts the following options:
  7236. @table @option
  7237. @item mode
  7238. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  7239. It accepts one of the following values:
  7240. @table @samp
  7241. @item fast
  7242. @item medium
  7243. @item slow
  7244. use iterative motion estimation
  7245. @item extra_slow
  7246. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  7247. @end table
  7248. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  7249. @item parity
  7250. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  7251. one of the following values:
  7252. @table @samp
  7253. @item 0, tff
  7254. assume top field first
  7255. @item 1, bff
  7256. assume bottom field first
  7257. @end table
  7258. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  7259. @item qp
  7260. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  7261. encoder.
  7262. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  7263. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  7264. @end table
  7265. @section mergeplanes
  7266. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  7267. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  7268. planes to the output video.
  7269. This filter accepts the following options:
  7270. @table @option
  7271. @item mapping
  7272. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  7273. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  7274. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  7275. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  7276. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  7277. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  7278. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  7279. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  7280. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  7281. @item format
  7282. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  7283. @end table
  7284. @subsection Examples
  7285. @itemize
  7286. @item
  7287. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  7288. @example
  7289. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  7290. @end example
  7291. @item
  7292. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  7293. @example
  7294. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  7295. @end example
  7296. @item
  7297. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  7298. @example
  7299. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  7300. @end example
  7301. @item
  7302. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  7303. @example
  7304. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  7305. @end example
  7306. @item
  7307. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  7308. @example
  7309. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  7310. @end example
  7311. @end itemize
  7312. @section mestimate
  7313. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  7314. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  7315. This filter accepts the following options:
  7316. @table @option
  7317. @item method
  7318. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  7319. @table @samp
  7320. @item esa
  7321. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  7322. @item tss
  7323. Three step search algorithm.
  7324. @item tdls
  7325. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  7326. @item ntss
  7327. New three step search algorithm.
  7328. @item fss
  7329. Four step search algorithm.
  7330. @item ds
  7331. Diamond search algorithm.
  7332. @item hexbs
  7333. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  7334. @item epzs
  7335. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  7336. @item umh
  7337. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  7338. @end table
  7339. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  7340. @item mb_size
  7341. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  7342. @item search_param
  7343. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  7344. @end table
  7345. @section minterpolate
  7346. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  7347. This filter accepts the following options:
  7348. @table @option
  7349. @item fps
  7350. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  7351. @item mi_mode
  7352. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7353. @table @samp
  7354. @item dup
  7355. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  7356. @item blend
  7357. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  7358. @item mci
  7359. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  7360. @table @samp
  7361. @item mc_mode
  7362. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7363. @table @samp
  7364. @item obmc
  7365. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  7366. @item aobmc
  7367. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  7368. @end table
  7369. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  7370. @item me_mode
  7371. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7372. @table @samp
  7373. @item bidir
  7374. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  7375. @item bilat
  7376. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  7377. @end table
  7378. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  7379. @item me
  7380. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  7381. @table @samp
  7382. @item esa
  7383. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  7384. @item tss
  7385. Three step search algorithm.
  7386. @item tdls
  7387. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  7388. @item ntss
  7389. New three step search algorithm.
  7390. @item fss
  7391. Four step search algorithm.
  7392. @item ds
  7393. Diamond search algorithm.
  7394. @item hexbs
  7395. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  7396. @item epzs
  7397. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  7398. @item umh
  7399. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  7400. @end table
  7401. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  7402. @item mb_size
  7403. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  7404. @item search_param
  7405. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  7406. @item vsmbc
  7407. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  7408. @end table
  7409. @end table
  7410. @item scd
  7411. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  7412. @table @samp
  7413. @item none
  7414. Disable scene change detection.
  7415. @item fdiff
  7416. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it statisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  7417. @end table
  7418. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  7419. @item scd_threshold
  7420. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  7421. @end table
  7422. @section mpdecimate
  7423. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  7424. order to reduce frame rate.
  7425. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  7426. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  7427. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  7428. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7429. @table @option
  7430. @item max
  7431. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  7432. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  7433. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped unregarding the
  7434. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  7435. Default value is 0.
  7436. @item hi
  7437. @item lo
  7438. @item frac
  7439. Set the dropping threshold values.
  7440. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  7441. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  7442. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  7443. out differently over the block.
  7444. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  7445. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  7446. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  7447. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  7448. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  7449. @end table
  7450. @section negate
  7451. Negate input video.
  7452. It accepts an integer in input; if non-zero it negates the
  7453. alpha component (if available). The default value in input is 0.
  7454. @section nnedi
  7455. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  7456. This filter accepts the following options:
  7457. @table @option
  7458. @item weights
  7459. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  7460. Currently file can be found here:
  7461. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  7462. @item deint
  7463. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  7464. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  7465. @item field
  7466. Set mode of operation.
  7467. Can be one of the following:
  7468. @table @samp
  7469. @item af
  7470. Use frame flags, both fields.
  7471. @item a
  7472. Use frame flags, single field.
  7473. @item t
  7474. Use top field only.
  7475. @item b
  7476. Use bottom field only.
  7477. @item tf
  7478. Use both fields, top first.
  7479. @item bf
  7480. Use both fields, bottom first.
  7481. @end table
  7482. @item planes
  7483. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  7484. @item nsize
  7485. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  7486. network.
  7487. Can be one of the following:
  7488. @table @samp
  7489. @item s8x6
  7490. @item s16x6
  7491. @item s32x6
  7492. @item s48x6
  7493. @item s8x4
  7494. @item s16x4
  7495. @item s32x4
  7496. @end table
  7497. @item nns
  7498. Set the number of neurons in predicctor neural network.
  7499. Can be one of the following:
  7500. @table @samp
  7501. @item n16
  7502. @item n32
  7503. @item n64
  7504. @item n128
  7505. @item n256
  7506. @end table
  7507. @item qual
  7508. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  7509. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  7510. @code{slow}.
  7511. @item etype
  7512. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  7513. Can be one of the following:
  7514. @table @samp
  7515. @item a
  7516. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  7517. @item s
  7518. weights trained to minimize squared error
  7519. @end table
  7520. @item pscrn
  7521. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  7522. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  7523. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  7524. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  7525. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  7526. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  7527. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  7528. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  7529. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  7530. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  7531. Can be one of the following:
  7532. @table @samp
  7533. @item none
  7534. @item original
  7535. @item new
  7536. @end table
  7537. Default is @code{new}.
  7538. @item fapprox
  7539. Set various debugging flags.
  7540. @end table
  7541. @section noformat
  7542. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  7543. input to the next filter.
  7544. It accepts the following parameters:
  7545. @table @option
  7546. @item pix_fmts
  7547. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  7548. apix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  7549. @end table
  7550. @subsection Examples
  7551. @itemize
  7552. @item
  7553. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  7554. input to the vflip filter:
  7555. @example
  7556. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  7557. @end example
  7558. @item
  7559. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  7560. @example
  7561. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  7562. @end example
  7563. @end itemize
  7564. @section noise
  7565. Add noise on video input frame.
  7566. The filter accepts the following options:
  7567. @table @option
  7568. @item all_seed
  7569. @item c0_seed
  7570. @item c1_seed
  7571. @item c2_seed
  7572. @item c3_seed
  7573. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  7574. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  7575. @item all_strength, alls
  7576. @item c0_strength, c0s
  7577. @item c1_strength, c1s
  7578. @item c2_strength, c2s
  7579. @item c3_strength, c3s
  7580. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  7581. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  7582. @item all_flags, allf
  7583. @item c0_flags, c0f
  7584. @item c1_flags, c1f
  7585. @item c2_flags, c2f
  7586. @item c3_flags, c3f
  7587. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  7588. Available values for component flags are:
  7589. @table @samp
  7590. @item a
  7591. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  7592. @item p
  7593. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  7594. @item t
  7595. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  7596. @item u
  7597. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  7598. @end table
  7599. @end table
  7600. @subsection Examples
  7601. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  7602. @example
  7603. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  7604. @end example
  7605. @section null
  7606. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  7607. @section ocr
  7608. Optical Character Recognition
  7609. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition.
  7610. It accepts the following options:
  7611. @table @option
  7612. @item datapath
  7613. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  7614. set at installation.
  7615. @item language
  7616. Set language, default is "eng".
  7617. @item whitelist
  7618. Set character whitelist.
  7619. @item blacklist
  7620. Set character blacklist.
  7621. @end table
  7622. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  7623. @section ocv
  7624. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  7625. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  7626. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  7627. It accepts the following parameters:
  7628. @table @option
  7629. @item filter_name
  7630. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  7631. @item filter_params
  7632. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  7633. values are assumed.
  7634. @end table
  7635. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  7636. information:
  7637. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  7638. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  7639. @anchor{dilate}
  7640. @subsection dilate
  7641. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  7642. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  7643. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  7644. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  7645. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  7646. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  7647. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  7648. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  7649. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  7650. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  7651. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  7652. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  7653. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  7654. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  7655. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  7656. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  7657. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  7658. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  7659. Some examples:
  7660. @example
  7661. # Use the default values
  7662. ocv=dilate
  7663. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  7664. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  7665. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  7666. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  7667. # *
  7668. # ***
  7669. # *****
  7670. # ***
  7671. # *
  7672. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  7673. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  7674. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  7675. @end example
  7676. @subsection erode
  7677. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  7678. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  7679. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  7680. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  7681. @subsection smooth
  7682. Smooth the input video.
  7683. The filter takes the following parameters:
  7684. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  7685. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  7686. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  7687. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  7688. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  7689. depend on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  7690. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  7691. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  7692. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  7693. other parameters is 0.
  7694. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  7695. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  7696. @anchor{overlay}
  7697. @section overlay
  7698. Overlay one video on top of another.
  7699. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  7700. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  7701. It accepts the following parameters:
  7702. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7703. @table @option
  7704. @item x
  7705. @item y
  7706. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  7707. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  7708. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  7709. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  7710. @item eof_action
  7711. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  7712. one of the following values:
  7713. @table @option
  7714. @item repeat
  7715. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  7716. @item endall
  7717. End both streams.
  7718. @item pass
  7719. Pass the main input through.
  7720. @end table
  7721. @item eval
  7722. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  7723. It accepts the following values:
  7724. @table @samp
  7725. @item init
  7726. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7727. when a command is processed
  7728. @item frame
  7729. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7730. @end table
  7731. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  7732. @item shortest
  7733. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  7734. terminates. Default value is 0.
  7735. @item format
  7736. Set the format for the output video.
  7737. It accepts the following values:
  7738. @table @samp
  7739. @item yuv420
  7740. force YUV420 output
  7741. @item yuv422
  7742. force YUV422 output
  7743. @item yuv444
  7744. force YUV444 output
  7745. @item rgb
  7746. force RGB output
  7747. @end table
  7748. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  7749. @item rgb @emph{(deprecated)}
  7750. If set to 1, force the filter to accept inputs in the RGB
  7751. color space. Default value is 0. This option is deprecated, use
  7752. @option{format} instead.
  7753. @item repeatlast
  7754. If set to 1, force the filter to draw the last overlay frame over the
  7755. main input until the end of the stream. A value of 0 disables this
  7756. behavior. Default value is 1.
  7757. @end table
  7758. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  7759. parameters.
  7760. @table @option
  7761. @item main_w, W
  7762. @item main_h, H
  7763. The main input width and height.
  7764. @item overlay_w, w
  7765. @item overlay_h, h
  7766. The overlay input width and height.
  7767. @item x
  7768. @item y
  7769. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  7770. each new frame.
  7771. @item hsub
  7772. @item vsub
  7773. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  7774. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  7775. @var{vsub} is 1.
  7776. @item n
  7777. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7778. @item pos
  7779. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  7780. @item t
  7781. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  7782. @end table
  7783. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  7784. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  7785. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  7786. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  7787. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  7788. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  7789. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  7790. the @var{movie} filter does.
  7791. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  7792. efficiency of such approach.
  7793. @subsection Commands
  7794. This filter supports the following commands:
  7795. @table @option
  7796. @item x
  7797. @item y
  7798. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  7799. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7800. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7801. value.
  7802. @end table
  7803. @subsection Examples
  7804. @itemize
  7805. @item
  7806. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  7807. video:
  7808. @example
  7809. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  7810. @end example
  7811. Using named options the example above becomes:
  7812. @example
  7813. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  7814. @end example
  7815. @item
  7816. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  7817. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  7818. @example
  7819. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  7820. @end example
  7821. @item
  7822. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  7823. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  7824. @example
  7825. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  7826. @end example
  7827. @item
  7828. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  7829. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  7830. @example
  7831. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  7832. @end example
  7833. @item
  7834. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  7835. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  7836. @example
  7837. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  7838. @end example
  7839. The above command is the same as:
  7840. @example
  7841. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  7842. @end example
  7843. @item
  7844. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  7845. screen starting since time 2:
  7846. @example
  7847. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  7848. @end example
  7849. @item
  7850. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  7851. @example
  7852. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  7853. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  7854. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  7855. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  7856. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  7857. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  7858. "
  7859. @end example
  7860. @item
  7861. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  7862. @example
  7863. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  7864. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  7865. masked.avi
  7866. @end example
  7867. @item
  7868. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  7869. @example
  7870. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  7871. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  7872. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  7873. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  7874. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  7875. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  7876. @end example
  7877. @end itemize
  7878. @section owdenoise
  7879. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  7880. The filter accepts the following options:
  7881. @table @option
  7882. @item depth
  7883. Set depth.
  7884. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  7885. slow down filtering.
  7886. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  7887. @item luma_strength, ls
  7888. Set luma strength.
  7889. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7890. @item chroma_strength, cs
  7891. Set chroma strength.
  7892. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7893. @end table
  7894. @anchor{pad}
  7895. @section pad
  7896. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  7897. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  7898. It accepts the following parameters:
  7899. @table @option
  7900. @item width, w
  7901. @item height, h
  7902. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  7903. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  7904. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  7905. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  7906. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  7907. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  7908. @item x
  7909. @item y
  7910. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  7911. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  7912. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  7913. expression, and vice versa.
  7914. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  7915. @item color
  7916. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  7917. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  7918. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  7919. @end table
  7920. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  7921. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  7922. @table @option
  7923. @item in_w
  7924. @item in_h
  7925. The input video width and height.
  7926. @item iw
  7927. @item ih
  7928. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  7929. @item out_w
  7930. @item out_h
  7931. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  7932. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  7933. @item ow
  7934. @item oh
  7935. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  7936. @item x
  7937. @item y
  7938. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  7939. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  7940. @item a
  7941. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  7942. @item sar
  7943. input sample aspect ratio
  7944. @item dar
  7945. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  7946. @item hsub
  7947. @item vsub
  7948. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7949. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7950. @end table
  7951. @subsection Examples
  7952. @itemize
  7953. @item
  7954. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  7955. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  7956. column 0, row 40
  7957. @example
  7958. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  7959. @end example
  7960. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  7961. @example
  7962. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  7963. @end example
  7964. @item
  7965. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  7966. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  7967. @example
  7968. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7969. @end example
  7970. @item
  7971. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  7972. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  7973. the center of the padded area:
  7974. @example
  7975. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7976. @end example
  7977. @item
  7978. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  7979. @example
  7980. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7981. @end example
  7982. @item
  7983. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  7984. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  7985. according to the relation:
  7986. @example
  7987. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  7988. X = output_dar / sar
  7989. @end example
  7990. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  7991. @example
  7992. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7993. @end example
  7994. @item
  7995. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  7996. corner of the output padded area:
  7997. @example
  7998. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  7999. @end example
  8000. @end itemize
  8001. @anchor{palettegen}
  8002. @section palettegen
  8003. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  8004. It accepts the following options:
  8005. @table @option
  8006. @item max_colors
  8007. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  8008. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  8009. will be black.
  8010. @item reserve_transparent
  8011. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  8012. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  8013. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  8014. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  8015. Set by default.
  8016. @item stats_mode
  8017. Set statistics mode.
  8018. It accepts the following values:
  8019. @table @samp
  8020. @item full
  8021. Compute full frame histograms.
  8022. @item diff
  8023. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  8024. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  8025. the background is static.
  8026. @item single
  8027. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  8028. @end table
  8029. Default value is @var{full}.
  8030. @end table
  8031. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  8032. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  8033. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  8034. @var{info} logging level.
  8035. @subsection Examples
  8036. @itemize
  8037. @item
  8038. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8039. @example
  8040. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  8041. @end example
  8042. @end itemize
  8043. @section paletteuse
  8044. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  8045. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  8046. be a 256 pixels image.
  8047. It accepts the following options:
  8048. @table @option
  8049. @item dither
  8050. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  8051. @table @samp
  8052. @item bayer
  8053. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  8054. @item heckbert
  8055. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  8056. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  8057. reference.
  8058. @item floyd_steinberg
  8059. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  8060. @item sierra2
  8061. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  8062. @item sierra2_4a
  8063. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  8064. @end table
  8065. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  8066. @item bayer_scale
  8067. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  8068. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  8069. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  8070. at the cost of more banding.
  8071. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  8072. @item diff_mode
  8073. If set, define the zone to process
  8074. @table @samp
  8075. @item rectangle
  8076. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  8077. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  8078. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  8079. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  8080. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  8081. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  8082. @end table
  8083. Default is @var{none}.
  8084. @item new
  8085. Take new palette for each output frame.
  8086. @end table
  8087. @subsection Examples
  8088. @itemize
  8089. @item
  8090. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  8091. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8092. @example
  8093. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  8094. @end example
  8095. @end itemize
  8096. @section perspective
  8097. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  8098. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8099. @table @option
  8100. @item x0
  8101. @item y0
  8102. @item x1
  8103. @item y1
  8104. @item x2
  8105. @item y2
  8106. @item x3
  8107. @item y3
  8108. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  8109. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  8110. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  8111. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  8112. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  8113. The expressions can use the following variables:
  8114. @table @option
  8115. @item W
  8116. @item H
  8117. the width and height of video frame.
  8118. @item in
  8119. Input frame count.
  8120. @item on
  8121. Output frame count.
  8122. @end table
  8123. @item interpolation
  8124. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  8125. It accepts the following values:
  8126. @table @samp
  8127. @item linear
  8128. @item cubic
  8129. @end table
  8130. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  8131. @item sense
  8132. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  8133. It accepts the following values:
  8134. @table @samp
  8135. @item 0, source
  8136. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  8137. the corners of the destination.
  8138. @item 1, destination
  8139. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  8140. by the given coordinates.
  8141. Default value is @samp{source}.
  8142. @end table
  8143. @item eval
  8144. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  8145. It accepts the following values:
  8146. @table @samp
  8147. @item init
  8148. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  8149. when a command is processed
  8150. @item frame
  8151. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  8152. @end table
  8153. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8154. @end table
  8155. @section phase
  8156. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  8157. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  8158. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  8159. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8160. @table @option
  8161. @item mode
  8162. Set phase mode.
  8163. It accepts the following values:
  8164. @table @samp
  8165. @item t
  8166. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  8167. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  8168. @item b
  8169. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  8170. Filter will delay the top field.
  8171. @item p
  8172. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  8173. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  8174. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  8175. @item a
  8176. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  8177. opposite.
  8178. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  8179. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  8180. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  8181. @item u
  8182. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  8183. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  8184. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  8185. match between the fields.
  8186. @item T
  8187. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  8188. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  8189. @item B
  8190. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  8191. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  8192. @item A
  8193. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  8194. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  8195. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  8196. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  8197. @item U
  8198. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  8199. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  8200. @end table
  8201. @end table
  8202. @section pixdesctest
  8203. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  8204. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  8205. For example:
  8206. @example
  8207. format=monow, pixdesctest
  8208. @end example
  8209. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  8210. @section pp
  8211. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  8212. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  8213. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  8214. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  8215. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  8216. The filters accept the following options:
  8217. @table @option
  8218. @item subfilters
  8219. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  8220. @end table
  8221. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  8222. @table @option
  8223. @item a/autoq
  8224. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  8225. @item c/chrom
  8226. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  8227. @item y/nochrom
  8228. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  8229. @item n/noluma
  8230. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  8231. @end table
  8232. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  8233. Available subfilters are:
  8234. @table @option
  8235. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8236. Horizontal deblocking filter
  8237. @table @option
  8238. @item difference
  8239. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8240. @item flatness
  8241. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8242. @end table
  8243. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8244. Vertical deblocking filter
  8245. @table @option
  8246. @item difference
  8247. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8248. @item flatness
  8249. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8250. @end table
  8251. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8252. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  8253. @table @option
  8254. @item difference
  8255. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8256. @item flatness
  8257. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8258. @end table
  8259. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8260. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  8261. @table @option
  8262. @item difference
  8263. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8264. @item flatness
  8265. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8266. @end table
  8267. @end table
  8268. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  8269. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  8270. thresholds.
  8271. @table @option
  8272. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  8273. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  8274. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  8275. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  8276. @item dr/dering
  8277. Deringing filter
  8278. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  8279. @table @option
  8280. @item threshold1
  8281. larger -> stronger filtering
  8282. @item threshold2
  8283. larger -> stronger filtering
  8284. @item threshold3
  8285. larger -> stronger filtering
  8286. @end table
  8287. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  8288. @table @option
  8289. @item f/fullyrange
  8290. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  8291. @end table
  8292. @item lb/linblenddeint
  8293. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  8294. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  8295. @item li/linipoldeint
  8296. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  8297. linearly interpolating every second line.
  8298. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  8299. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  8300. cubically interpolating every second line.
  8301. @item md/mediandeint
  8302. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  8303. median filter to every second line.
  8304. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  8305. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  8306. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  8307. @item l5/lowpass5
  8308. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  8309. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  8310. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  8311. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  8312. specify.
  8313. @table @option
  8314. @item quantizer
  8315. Quantizer to use
  8316. @end table
  8317. @item de/default
  8318. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  8319. @item fa/fast
  8320. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  8321. @item ac
  8322. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  8323. @end table
  8324. @subsection Examples
  8325. @itemize
  8326. @item
  8327. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  8328. brightness/contrast:
  8329. @example
  8330. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  8331. @end example
  8332. @item
  8333. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  8334. @example
  8335. pp=de/-al
  8336. @end example
  8337. @item
  8338. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  8339. @example
  8340. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  8341. @end example
  8342. @item
  8343. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  8344. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  8345. @example
  8346. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  8347. @end example
  8348. @end itemize
  8349. @section pp7
  8350. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  8351. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  8352. used after IDCT.
  8353. The filter accepts the following options:
  8354. @table @option
  8355. @item qp
  8356. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  8357. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  8358. (if available).
  8359. @item mode
  8360. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  8361. @table @samp
  8362. @item hard
  8363. Set hard thresholding.
  8364. @item soft
  8365. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  8366. @item medium
  8367. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  8368. @end table
  8369. @end table
  8370. @section prewitt
  8371. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  8372. The filter accepts the following option:
  8373. @table @option
  8374. @item planes
  8375. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  8376. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  8377. @item scale
  8378. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  8379. @item delta
  8380. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  8381. @end table
  8382. @section psnr
  8383. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  8384. Ratio) between two input videos.
  8385. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  8386. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  8387. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  8388. the PSNR.
  8389. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  8390. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  8391. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  8392. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  8393. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  8394. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  8395. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  8396. @example
  8397. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  8398. @end example
  8399. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  8400. image.
  8401. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8402. @table @option
  8403. @item stats_file, f
  8404. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  8405. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  8406. standard output.
  8407. @item stats_version
  8408. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  8409. each format are written below.
  8410. Default value is 1.
  8411. @item stats_add_max
  8412. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  8413. Default value is 0.
  8414. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  8415. the filter will return an error.
  8416. @end table
  8417. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  8418. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  8419. couple of frames.
  8420. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  8421. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  8422. format with the following parameters:
  8423. @table @option
  8424. @item psnr_log_version
  8425. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  8426. @item fields
  8427. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  8428. the log.
  8429. @end table
  8430. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  8431. @table @option
  8432. @item n
  8433. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  8434. @item mse_avg
  8435. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  8436. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  8437. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_g, mse_a
  8438. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  8439. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  8440. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  8441. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  8442. specified by the suffix.
  8443. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  8444. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  8445. channels.
  8446. @end table
  8447. For example:
  8448. @example
  8449. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  8450. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  8451. @end example
  8452. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  8453. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  8454. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  8455. @anchor{pullup}
  8456. @section pullup
  8457. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  8458. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  8459. content.
  8460. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  8461. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  8462. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  8463. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  8464. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  8465. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  8466. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  8467. The filter accepts the following options:
  8468. @table @option
  8469. @item jl
  8470. @item jr
  8471. @item jt
  8472. @item jb
  8473. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  8474. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  8475. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  8476. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  8477. @item sb
  8478. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  8479. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  8480. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  8481. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  8482. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  8483. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  8484. Default value is @code{0}.
  8485. @item mp
  8486. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  8487. @table @samp
  8488. @item l
  8489. Use luma plane.
  8490. @item u
  8491. Use chroma blue plane.
  8492. @item v
  8493. Use chroma red plane.
  8494. @end table
  8495. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  8496. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  8497. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  8498. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  8499. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  8500. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  8501. @end table
  8502. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  8503. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  8504. telecine NTSC input:
  8505. @example
  8506. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  8507. @end example
  8508. @section qp
  8509. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  8510. The filter accepts the following option:
  8511. @table @option
  8512. @item qp
  8513. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  8514. @end table
  8515. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  8516. the following constants:
  8517. @table @var
  8518. @item known
  8519. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  8520. @item qp
  8521. Sequentional index starting from -129 to 128.
  8522. @end table
  8523. @subsection Examples
  8524. @itemize
  8525. @item
  8526. Some equation like:
  8527. @example
  8528. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  8529. @end example
  8530. @end itemize
  8531. @section random
  8532. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  8533. No frame is discarded.
  8534. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  8535. @table @option
  8536. @item frames
  8537. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  8538. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  8539. @item seed
  8540. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  8541. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  8542. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  8543. best effort basis.
  8544. @end table
  8545. @section readvitc
  8546. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  8547. video frame.
  8548. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  8549. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  8550. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  8551. timecode data has been found or not.
  8552. This filter accepts the following options:
  8553. @table @option
  8554. @item scan_max
  8555. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  8556. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  8557. @item thr_b
  8558. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  8559. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  8560. @item thr_w
  8561. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  8562. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  8563. @end table
  8564. @subsection Examples
  8565. @itemize
  8566. @item
  8567. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  8568. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  8569. @example
  8570. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  8571. @end example
  8572. @end itemize
  8573. @section remap
  8574. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  8575. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  8576. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  8577. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  8578. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  8579. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  8580. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  8581. @section removegrain
  8582. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  8583. @table @option
  8584. @item m0
  8585. Set mode for the first plane.
  8586. @item m1
  8587. Set mode for the second plane.
  8588. @item m2
  8589. Set mode for the third plane.
  8590. @item m3
  8591. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  8592. @end table
  8593. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  8594. @table @var
  8595. @item 0
  8596. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  8597. @item 1
  8598. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8599. @item 2
  8600. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8601. @item 3
  8602. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8603. @item 4
  8604. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8605. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  8606. @item 5
  8607. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  8608. @item 6
  8609. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8610. @item 7
  8611. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8612. @item 8
  8613. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8614. @item 9
  8615. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  8616. @item 10
  8617. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  8618. @item 11
  8619. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  8620. @item 12
  8621. Same as mode 11.
  8622. @item 13
  8623. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  8624. pixels are the closest.
  8625. @item 14
  8626. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  8627. pixels are the closest.
  8628. @item 15
  8629. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  8630. interpolation formula.
  8631. @item 16
  8632. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  8633. interpolation formula.
  8634. @item 17
  8635. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  8636. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  8637. @item 18
  8638. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  8639. the current pixel is minimal.
  8640. @item 19
  8641. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  8642. @item 20
  8643. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  8644. @item 21
  8645. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  8646. @item 22
  8647. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  8648. @item 23
  8649. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  8650. @item 24
  8651. Similar as 23.
  8652. @end table
  8653. @section removelogo
  8654. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  8655. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  8656. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  8657. The filter accepts the following options:
  8658. @table @option
  8659. @item filename, f
  8660. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  8661. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  8662. video stream being processed.
  8663. @end table
  8664. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  8665. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  8666. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  8667. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  8668. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  8669. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  8670. filter once or twice.
  8671. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  8672. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  8673. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  8674. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  8675. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  8676. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  8677. @section repeatfields
  8678. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  8679. fields based on its value.
  8680. @section reverse
  8681. Reverse a video clip.
  8682. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  8683. is suggested.
  8684. @subsection Examples
  8685. @itemize
  8686. @item
  8687. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  8688. @example
  8689. trim=end=5,reverse
  8690. @end example
  8691. @end itemize
  8692. @section rotate
  8693. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  8694. The filter accepts the following options:
  8695. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  8696. @table @option
  8697. @item angle, a
  8698. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  8699. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  8700. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  8701. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  8702. @item out_w, ow
  8703. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  8704. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  8705. @item out_h, oh
  8706. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  8707. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  8708. @item bilinear
  8709. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  8710. it. Default value is 1.
  8711. @item fillcolor, c
  8712. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  8713. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  8714. ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  8715. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  8716. Default value is "black".
  8717. @end table
  8718. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  8719. following constants and functions:
  8720. @table @option
  8721. @item n
  8722. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  8723. before the first frame is filtered.
  8724. @item t
  8725. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  8726. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  8727. @item hsub
  8728. @item vsub
  8729. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8730. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8731. @item in_w, iw
  8732. @item in_h, ih
  8733. the input video width and height
  8734. @item out_w, ow
  8735. @item out_h, oh
  8736. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  8737. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  8738. @item rotw(a)
  8739. @item roth(a)
  8740. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  8741. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  8742. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  8743. @option{out_h} expressions.
  8744. @end table
  8745. @subsection Examples
  8746. @itemize
  8747. @item
  8748. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  8749. @example
  8750. rotate=PI/6
  8751. @end example
  8752. @item
  8753. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  8754. @example
  8755. rotate=-PI/6
  8756. @end example
  8757. @item
  8758. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  8759. @example
  8760. rotate=45*PI/180
  8761. @end example
  8762. @item
  8763. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  8764. @example
  8765. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  8766. @end example
  8767. @item
  8768. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  8769. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  8770. @example
  8771. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  8772. @end example
  8773. @item
  8774. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  8775. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  8776. @example
  8777. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  8778. @end example
  8779. @item
  8780. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  8781. shown:
  8782. @example
  8783. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  8784. @end example
  8785. @end itemize
  8786. @subsection Commands
  8787. The filter supports the following commands:
  8788. @table @option
  8789. @item a, angle
  8790. Set the angle expression.
  8791. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8792. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8793. value.
  8794. @end table
  8795. @section sab
  8796. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  8797. The filter accepts the following options:
  8798. @table @option
  8799. @item luma_radius, lr
  8800. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  8801. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  8802. in slower processing.
  8803. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  8804. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  8805. value is 1.0.
  8806. @item luma_strength, ls
  8807. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  8808. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  8809. @item chroma_radius, cr
  8810. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  8811. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  8812. processing.
  8813. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  8814. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  8815. @item chroma_strength, cs
  8816. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  8817. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  8818. @end table
  8819. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  8820. corresponding luma option value.
  8821. @anchor{scale}
  8822. @section scale
  8823. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  8824. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  8825. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  8826. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  8827. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  8828. requested format.
  8829. @subsection Options
  8830. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  8831. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  8832. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  8833. the complete list of scaler options.
  8834. @table @option
  8835. @item width, w
  8836. @item height, h
  8837. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  8838. dimension.
  8839. If the value is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  8840. If one of the values is -1, the scale filter will use a value that
  8841. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  8842. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  8843. used
  8844. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the scale filter will also use a value
  8845. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  8846. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  8847. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  8848. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  8849. expression.
  8850. @item eval
  8851. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  8852. @table @samp
  8853. @item init
  8854. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  8855. @item frame
  8856. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8857. @end table
  8858. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8859. @item interl
  8860. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  8861. @table @samp
  8862. @item 1
  8863. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  8864. @item 0
  8865. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  8866. @item -1
  8867. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  8868. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  8869. @end table
  8870. Default value is @samp{0}.
  8871. @item flags
  8872. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  8873. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8874. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8875. the default flags.
  8876. @item param0, param1
  8877. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  8878. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8879. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8880. empty parameters.
  8881. @item size, s
  8882. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  8883. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  8884. @item in_color_matrix
  8885. @item out_color_matrix
  8886. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  8887. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8888. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  8889. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  8890. Possible values:
  8891. @table @samp
  8892. @item auto
  8893. Choose automatically.
  8894. @item bt709
  8895. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  8896. Recommendation BT.709.
  8897. @item fcc
  8898. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  8899. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  8900. @item bt601
  8901. Set color space conforming to:
  8902. @itemize
  8903. @item
  8904. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  8905. @item
  8906. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  8907. @item
  8908. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  8909. @end itemize
  8910. @item smpte240m
  8911. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  8912. @end table
  8913. @item in_range
  8914. @item out_range
  8915. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  8916. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8917. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  8918. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  8919. @table @samp
  8920. @item auto
  8921. Choose automatically.
  8922. @item jpeg/full/pc
  8923. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8924. @item mpeg/tv
  8925. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8926. @end table
  8927. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  8928. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  8929. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  8930. @table @samp
  8931. @item disable
  8932. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  8933. @item decrease
  8934. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  8935. @item increase
  8936. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  8937. @end table
  8938. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  8939. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  8940. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  8941. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  8942. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  8943. 1280x533.
  8944. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  8945. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  8946. to work.
  8947. @end table
  8948. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  8949. containing the following constants:
  8950. @table @var
  8951. @item in_w
  8952. @item in_h
  8953. The input width and height
  8954. @item iw
  8955. @item ih
  8956. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  8957. @item out_w
  8958. @item out_h
  8959. The output (scaled) width and height
  8960. @item ow
  8961. @item oh
  8962. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  8963. @item a
  8964. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  8965. @item sar
  8966. input sample aspect ratio
  8967. @item dar
  8968. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  8969. @item hsub
  8970. @item vsub
  8971. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8972. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8973. @item ohsub
  8974. @item ovsub
  8975. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8976. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8977. @end table
  8978. @subsection Examples
  8979. @itemize
  8980. @item
  8981. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  8982. @example
  8983. scale=w=200:h=100
  8984. @end example
  8985. This is equivalent to:
  8986. @example
  8987. scale=200:100
  8988. @end example
  8989. or:
  8990. @example
  8991. scale=200x100
  8992. @end example
  8993. @item
  8994. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  8995. @example
  8996. scale=qcif
  8997. @end example
  8998. which can also be written as:
  8999. @example
  9000. scale=size=qcif
  9001. @end example
  9002. @item
  9003. Scale the input to 2x:
  9004. @example
  9005. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  9006. @end example
  9007. @item
  9008. The above is the same as:
  9009. @example
  9010. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  9011. @end example
  9012. @item
  9013. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  9014. @example
  9015. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  9016. @end example
  9017. @item
  9018. Scale the input to half size:
  9019. @example
  9020. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  9021. @end example
  9022. @item
  9023. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  9024. @example
  9025. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  9026. @end example
  9027. @item
  9028. Seek Greek harmony:
  9029. @example
  9030. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  9031. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  9032. @end example
  9033. @item
  9034. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  9035. @example
  9036. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  9037. @end example
  9038. @item
  9039. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  9040. subsample values:
  9041. @example
  9042. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  9043. @end example
  9044. @item
  9045. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  9046. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  9047. @example
  9048. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  9049. @end example
  9050. @end itemize
  9051. @subsection Commands
  9052. This filter supports the following commands:
  9053. @table @option
  9054. @item width, w
  9055. @item height, h
  9056. Set the output video dimension expression.
  9057. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9058. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9059. value.
  9060. @end table
  9061. @section scale_npp
  9062. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  9063. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  9064. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  9065. The following additional options are accepted:
  9066. @table @option
  9067. @item format
  9068. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  9069. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  9070. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  9071. @item interp_algo
  9072. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  9073. @table @option
  9074. @item nn
  9075. Nearest neighbour.
  9076. @item linear
  9077. @item cubic
  9078. @item cubic2p_bspline
  9079. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  9080. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  9081. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  9082. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  9083. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  9084. @item super
  9085. Supersampling
  9086. @item lanczos
  9087. @end table
  9088. @end table
  9089. @section scale2ref
  9090. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  9091. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  9092. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis.
  9093. @subsection Examples
  9094. @itemize
  9095. @item
  9096. Scale a subtitle stream to match the main video in size before overlaying
  9097. @example
  9098. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  9099. @end example
  9100. @end itemize
  9101. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  9102. @section selectivecolor
  9103. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  9104. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  9105. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  9106. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  9107. The filter accepts the following options:
  9108. @table @option
  9109. @item correction_method
  9110. Select color correction method.
  9111. Available values are:
  9112. @table @samp
  9113. @item absolute
  9114. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  9115. component value).
  9116. @item relative
  9117. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  9118. @end table
  9119. Default is @code{absolute}.
  9120. @item reds
  9121. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  9122. @item yellows
  9123. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  9124. @item greens
  9125. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  9126. @item cyans
  9127. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  9128. @item blues
  9129. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  9130. @item magentas
  9131. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  9132. @item whites
  9133. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  9134. @item neutrals
  9135. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  9136. @item blacks
  9137. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  9138. @item psfile
  9139. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  9140. @end table
  9141. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  9142. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  9143. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  9144. pixels of its range.
  9145. @subsection Examples
  9146. @itemize
  9147. @item
  9148. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  9149. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  9150. @example
  9151. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  9152. @end example
  9153. @item
  9154. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  9155. @example
  9156. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  9157. @end example
  9158. @end itemize
  9159. @anchor{separatefields}
  9160. @section separatefields
  9161. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  9162. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  9163. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  9164. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  9165. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  9166. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  9167. @section setdar, setsar
  9168. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  9169. output video.
  9170. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  9171. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  9172. @example
  9173. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  9174. @end example
  9175. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  9176. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  9177. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  9178. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  9179. applied.
  9180. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  9181. the filter output video.
  9182. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  9183. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  9184. above.
  9185. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  9186. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  9187. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  9188. It accepts the following parameters:
  9189. @table @option
  9190. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  9191. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  9192. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  9193. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  9194. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  9195. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  9196. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  9197. should be escaped.
  9198. @item max
  9199. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  9200. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  9201. Default value is @code{100}.
  9202. @end table
  9203. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  9204. the following constants:
  9205. @table @option
  9206. @item E, PI, PHI
  9207. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  9208. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  9209. @item w, h
  9210. The input width and height.
  9211. @item a
  9212. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  9213. @item sar
  9214. The input sample aspect ratio.
  9215. @item dar
  9216. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  9217. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  9218. @item hsub, vsub
  9219. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  9220. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  9221. @end table
  9222. @subsection Examples
  9223. @itemize
  9224. @item
  9225. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  9226. @example
  9227. setdar=dar=1.77777
  9228. setdar=dar=16/9
  9229. @end example
  9230. @item
  9231. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  9232. @example
  9233. setsar=sar=10/11
  9234. @end example
  9235. @item
  9236. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  9237. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  9238. @example
  9239. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  9240. @end example
  9241. @end itemize
  9242. @anchor{setfield}
  9243. @section setfield
  9244. Force field for the output video frame.
  9245. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  9246. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  9247. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  9248. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  9249. The filter accepts the following options:
  9250. @table @option
  9251. @item mode
  9252. Available values are:
  9253. @table @samp
  9254. @item auto
  9255. Keep the same field property.
  9256. @item bff
  9257. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  9258. @item tff
  9259. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  9260. @item prog
  9261. Mark the frame as progressive.
  9262. @end table
  9263. @end table
  9264. @section showinfo
  9265. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  9266. The input video is not modified.
  9267. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  9268. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  9269. The following values are shown in the output:
  9270. @table @option
  9271. @item n
  9272. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  9273. @item pts
  9274. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  9275. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  9276. @item pts_time
  9277. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  9278. seconds.
  9279. @item pos
  9280. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  9281. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  9282. @item fmt
  9283. The pixel format name.
  9284. @item sar
  9285. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  9286. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  9287. @item s
  9288. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9289. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9290. @item i
  9291. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  9292. for bottom field first).
  9293. @item iskey
  9294. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  9295. @item type
  9296. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  9297. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  9298. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  9299. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  9300. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  9301. @item checksum
  9302. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  9303. @item plane_checksum
  9304. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  9305. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  9306. @end table
  9307. @section showpalette
  9308. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  9309. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  9310. It accepts the following option:
  9311. @table @option
  9312. @item s
  9313. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  9314. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  9315. @end table
  9316. @section shuffleframes
  9317. Reorder and/or duplicate video frames.
  9318. It accepts the following parameters:
  9319. @table @option
  9320. @item mapping
  9321. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  9322. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  9323. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  9324. @end table
  9325. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  9326. @subsection Examples
  9327. @itemize
  9328. @item
  9329. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  9330. @example
  9331. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  9332. @end example
  9333. @item
  9334. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  9335. @example
  9336. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  9337. @end example
  9338. @end itemize
  9339. @section shuffleplanes
  9340. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  9341. It accepts the following parameters:
  9342. @table @option
  9343. @item map0
  9344. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  9345. @item map1
  9346. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  9347. @item map2
  9348. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  9349. @item map3
  9350. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  9351. @end table
  9352. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  9353. @subsection Examples
  9354. @itemize
  9355. @item
  9356. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  9357. @example
  9358. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  9359. @end example
  9360. @end itemize
  9361. @anchor{signalstats}
  9362. @section signalstats
  9363. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  9364. with the digitization of analog video media.
  9365. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  9366. @table @option
  9367. @item YMIN
  9368. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9369. range of [0-255].
  9370. @item YLOW
  9371. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9372. range of [0-255].
  9373. @item YAVG
  9374. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9375. [0-255].
  9376. @item YHIGH
  9377. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9378. range of [0-255].
  9379. @item YMAX
  9380. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9381. range of [0-255].
  9382. @item UMIN
  9383. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9384. range of [0-255].
  9385. @item ULOW
  9386. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9387. range of [0-255].
  9388. @item UAVG
  9389. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9390. [0-255].
  9391. @item UHIGH
  9392. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9393. range of [0-255].
  9394. @item UMAX
  9395. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9396. range of [0-255].
  9397. @item VMIN
  9398. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9399. range of [0-255].
  9400. @item VLOW
  9401. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9402. range of [0-255].
  9403. @item VAVG
  9404. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9405. [0-255].
  9406. @item VHIGH
  9407. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9408. range of [0-255].
  9409. @item VMAX
  9410. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9411. range of [0-255].
  9412. @item SATMIN
  9413. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  9414. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9415. @item SATLOW
  9416. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  9417. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9418. @item SATAVG
  9419. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  9420. of [0-~181.02].
  9421. @item SATHIGH
  9422. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  9423. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9424. @item SATMAX
  9425. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  9426. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9427. @item HUEMED
  9428. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9429. [0-360].
  9430. @item HUEAVG
  9431. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9432. [0-360].
  9433. @item YDIF
  9434. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  9435. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9436. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9437. @item UDIF
  9438. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  9439. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9440. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9441. @item VDIF
  9442. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  9443. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9444. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9445. @item YBITDEPTH
  9446. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  9447. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9448. @item UBITDEPTH
  9449. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  9450. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9451. @item VBITDEPTH
  9452. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  9453. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9454. @end table
  9455. The filter accepts the following options:
  9456. @table @option
  9457. @item stat
  9458. @item out
  9459. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  9460. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  9461. Both options accept the following values:
  9462. @table @samp
  9463. @item tout
  9464. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  9465. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  9466. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  9467. @item vrep
  9468. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  9469. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  9470. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  9471. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  9472. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  9473. @item brng
  9474. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  9475. @end table
  9476. @item color, c
  9477. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  9478. yellow.
  9479. @end table
  9480. @subsection Examples
  9481. @itemize
  9482. @item
  9483. Output data of various video metrics:
  9484. @example
  9485. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  9486. @end example
  9487. @item
  9488. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  9489. @example
  9490. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  9491. @end example
  9492. @item
  9493. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  9494. @example
  9495. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  9496. @end example
  9497. @item
  9498. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  9499. @example
  9500. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  9501. @end example
  9502. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  9503. @example
  9504. time %@{pts:hms@}
  9505. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  9506. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  9507. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  9508. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  9509. @end example
  9510. @end itemize
  9511. @anchor{smartblur}
  9512. @section smartblur
  9513. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  9514. It accepts the following options:
  9515. @table @option
  9516. @item luma_radius, lr
  9517. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  9518. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  9519. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  9520. @item luma_strength, ls
  9521. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  9522. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  9523. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  9524. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  9525. @item luma_threshold, lt
  9526. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  9527. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  9528. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  9529. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  9530. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  9531. @item chroma_radius, cr
  9532. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  9533. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  9534. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  9535. @item chroma_strength, cs
  9536. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  9537. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  9538. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  9539. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  9540. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  9541. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  9542. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  9543. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  9544. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  9545. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  9546. @end table
  9547. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  9548. is set.
  9549. @section ssim
  9550. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  9551. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  9552. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  9553. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  9554. the SSIM.
  9555. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  9556. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  9557. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  9558. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  9559. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9560. @table @option
  9561. @item stats_file, f
  9562. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  9563. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  9564. standard output.
  9565. @end table
  9566. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  9567. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  9568. couple of frames.
  9569. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  9570. @table @option
  9571. @item n
  9572. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  9573. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  9574. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  9575. @item All
  9576. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  9577. @item dB
  9578. Same as above but in dB representation.
  9579. @end table
  9580. For example:
  9581. @example
  9582. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  9583. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  9584. @end example
  9585. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  9586. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  9587. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  9588. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  9589. @example
  9590. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  9591. @end example
  9592. @section stereo3d
  9593. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  9594. The filters accept the following options:
  9595. @table @option
  9596. @item in
  9597. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  9598. Available values for input image formats are:
  9599. @table @samp
  9600. @item sbsl
  9601. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  9602. @item sbsr
  9603. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  9604. @item sbs2l
  9605. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  9606. (left eye left, right eye right)
  9607. @item sbs2r
  9608. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  9609. (right eye left, left eye right)
  9610. @item abl
  9611. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  9612. @item abr
  9613. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  9614. @item ab2l
  9615. above-below with half height resolution
  9616. (left eye above, right eye below)
  9617. @item ab2r
  9618. above-below with half height resolution
  9619. (right eye above, left eye below)
  9620. @item al
  9621. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  9622. @item ar
  9623. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  9624. @item irl
  9625. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  9626. @item irr
  9627. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  9628. @item icl
  9629. interleaved columns, left eye first
  9630. @item icr
  9631. interleaved columns, right eye first
  9632. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  9633. @end table
  9634. @item out
  9635. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  9636. @table @samp
  9637. @item sbsl
  9638. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  9639. @item sbsr
  9640. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  9641. @item sbs2l
  9642. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  9643. (left eye left, right eye right)
  9644. @item sbs2r
  9645. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  9646. (right eye left, left eye right)
  9647. @item abl
  9648. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  9649. @item abr
  9650. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  9651. @item ab2l
  9652. above-below with half height resolution
  9653. (left eye above, right eye below)
  9654. @item ab2r
  9655. above-below with half height resolution
  9656. (right eye above, left eye below)
  9657. @item al
  9658. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  9659. @item ar
  9660. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  9661. @item irl
  9662. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  9663. @item irr
  9664. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  9665. @item arbg
  9666. anaglyph red/blue gray
  9667. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9668. @item argg
  9669. anaglyph red/green gray
  9670. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  9671. @item arcg
  9672. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  9673. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9674. @item arch
  9675. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  9676. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9677. @item arcc
  9678. anaglyph red/cyan color
  9679. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9680. @item arcd
  9681. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9682. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9683. @item agmg
  9684. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  9685. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9686. @item agmh
  9687. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  9688. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9689. @item agmc
  9690. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  9691. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9692. @item agmd
  9693. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9694. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9695. @item aybg
  9696. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  9697. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9698. @item aybh
  9699. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  9700. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9701. @item aybc
  9702. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  9703. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9704. @item aybd
  9705. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9706. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9707. @item ml
  9708. mono output (left eye only)
  9709. @item mr
  9710. mono output (right eye only)
  9711. @item chl
  9712. checkerboard, left eye first
  9713. @item chr
  9714. checkerboard, right eye first
  9715. @item icl
  9716. interleaved columns, left eye first
  9717. @item icr
  9718. interleaved columns, right eye first
  9719. @item hdmi
  9720. HDMI frame pack
  9721. @end table
  9722. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  9723. @end table
  9724. @subsection Examples
  9725. @itemize
  9726. @item
  9727. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  9728. @example
  9729. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  9730. @end example
  9731. @item
  9732. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  9733. @example
  9734. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  9735. @end example
  9736. @end itemize
  9737. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  9738. Select video or audio streams.
  9739. The filter accepts the following options:
  9740. @table @option
  9741. @item inputs
  9742. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  9743. @item map
  9744. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  9745. @end table
  9746. @subsection Commands
  9747. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  9748. commands:
  9749. @table @option
  9750. @item map
  9751. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  9752. @end table
  9753. @subsection Examples
  9754. @itemize
  9755. @item
  9756. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  9757. @example
  9758. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  9759. @end example
  9760. @item
  9761. Same as above, but for audio:
  9762. @example
  9763. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  9764. @end example
  9765. @end itemize
  9766. @section sobel
  9767. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  9768. The filter accepts the following option:
  9769. @table @option
  9770. @item planes
  9771. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  9772. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9773. @item scale
  9774. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  9775. @item delta
  9776. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  9777. @end table
  9778. @anchor{spp}
  9779. @section spp
  9780. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  9781. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  9782. and average the results.
  9783. The filter accepts the following options:
  9784. @table @option
  9785. @item quality
  9786. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  9787. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  9788. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  9789. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  9790. @code{3}.
  9791. @item qp
  9792. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  9793. from the video stream (if available).
  9794. @item mode
  9795. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  9796. @table @samp
  9797. @item hard
  9798. Set hard thresholding (default).
  9799. @item soft
  9800. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  9801. @end table
  9802. @item use_bframe_qp
  9803. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  9804. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  9805. @code{0} (not enabled).
  9806. @end table
  9807. @anchor{subtitles}
  9808. @section subtitles
  9809. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  9810. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  9811. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  9812. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  9813. Alpha) subtitles format.
  9814. The filter accepts the following options:
  9815. @table @option
  9816. @item filename, f
  9817. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  9818. @item original_size
  9819. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  9820. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9821. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9822. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  9823. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  9824. @item fontsdir
  9825. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  9826. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  9827. @item charenc
  9828. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  9829. useful if not UTF-8.
  9830. @item stream_index, si
  9831. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  9832. @item force_style
  9833. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  9834. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  9835. @end table
  9836. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  9837. specifies the @option{filename}.
  9838. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  9839. video, use the command:
  9840. @example
  9841. subtitles=sub.srt
  9842. @end example
  9843. which is equivalent to:
  9844. @example
  9845. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  9846. @end example
  9847. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  9848. @example
  9849. subtitles=video.mkv
  9850. @end example
  9851. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  9852. @example
  9853. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  9854. @end example
  9855. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in transparent green
  9856. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  9857. @example
  9858. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HAA00FF00'
  9859. @end example
  9860. @section super2xsai
  9861. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  9862. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  9863. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  9864. @section swaprect
  9865. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  9866. This filter accepts the following options:
  9867. @table @option
  9868. @item w
  9869. Set object width.
  9870. @item h
  9871. Set object height.
  9872. @item x1
  9873. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  9874. @item y1
  9875. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  9876. @item x2
  9877. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  9878. @item y2
  9879. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  9880. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  9881. @end table
  9882. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  9883. @table @option
  9884. @item w
  9885. @item h
  9886. The input width and height.
  9887. @item a
  9888. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  9889. @item sar
  9890. input sample aspect ratio
  9891. @item dar
  9892. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  9893. @item n
  9894. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  9895. @item t
  9896. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  9897. @item pos
  9898. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  9899. @end table
  9900. @section swapuv
  9901. Swap U & V plane.
  9902. @section telecine
  9903. Apply telecine process to the video.
  9904. This filter accepts the following options:
  9905. @table @option
  9906. @item first_field
  9907. @table @samp
  9908. @item top, t
  9909. top field first
  9910. @item bottom, b
  9911. bottom field first
  9912. The default value is @code{top}.
  9913. @end table
  9914. @item pattern
  9915. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  9916. The default value is @code{23}.
  9917. @end table
  9918. @example
  9919. Some typical patterns:
  9920. NTSC output (30i):
  9921. 27.5p: 32222
  9922. 24p: 23 (classic)
  9923. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  9924. 20p: 33
  9925. 18p: 334
  9926. 16p: 3444
  9927. PAL output (25i):
  9928. 27.5p: 12222
  9929. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  9930. 16.67p: 33
  9931. 16p: 33333334
  9932. @end example
  9933. @section thumbnail
  9934. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  9935. The filter accepts the following options:
  9936. @table @option
  9937. @item n
  9938. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  9939. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  9940. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  9941. @end table
  9942. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  9943. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  9944. @subsection Examples
  9945. @itemize
  9946. @item
  9947. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  9948. @example
  9949. thumbnail=50
  9950. @end example
  9951. @item
  9952. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9953. @example
  9954. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  9955. @end example
  9956. @end itemize
  9957. @section tile
  9958. Tile several successive frames together.
  9959. The filter accepts the following options:
  9960. @table @option
  9961. @item layout
  9962. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  9963. this option, check the
  9964. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9965. @item nb_frames
  9966. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  9967. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  9968. the area will be used.
  9969. @item margin
  9970. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  9971. @item padding
  9972. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  9973. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  9974. refer to the pad video filter.
  9975. @item color
  9976. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9977. "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. The default value of @var{color}
  9978. is "black".
  9979. @end table
  9980. @subsection Examples
  9981. @itemize
  9982. @item
  9983. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  9984. @example
  9985. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  9986. @end example
  9987. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  9988. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  9989. rate.
  9990. @item
  9991. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  9992. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  9993. mixed flat and named options:
  9994. @example
  9995. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  9996. @end example
  9997. @end itemize
  9998. @section tinterlace
  9999. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  10000. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  10001. considered odd.
  10002. The filter accepts the following options:
  10003. @table @option
  10004. @item mode
  10005. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  10006. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  10007. Available values are:
  10008. @table @samp
  10009. @item merge, 0
  10010. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  10011. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  10012. @example
  10013. ------> time
  10014. Input:
  10015. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10016. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10017. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10018. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10019. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10020. Output:
  10021. 11111 33333
  10022. 22222 44444
  10023. 11111 33333
  10024. 22222 44444
  10025. 11111 33333
  10026. 22222 44444
  10027. 11111 33333
  10028. 22222 44444
  10029. @end example
  10030. @item drop_even, 1
  10031. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  10032. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10033. @example
  10034. ------> time
  10035. Input:
  10036. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10037. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10038. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10039. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10040. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10041. Output:
  10042. 11111 33333
  10043. 11111 33333
  10044. 11111 33333
  10045. 11111 33333
  10046. @end example
  10047. @item drop_odd, 2
  10048. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  10049. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10050. @example
  10051. ------> time
  10052. Input:
  10053. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10054. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10055. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10056. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10057. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10058. Output:
  10059. 22222 44444
  10060. 22222 44444
  10061. 22222 44444
  10062. 22222 44444
  10063. @end example
  10064. @item pad, 3
  10065. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  10066. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  10067. @example
  10068. ------> time
  10069. Input:
  10070. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10071. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10072. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10073. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10074. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10075. Output:
  10076. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10077. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10078. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10079. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10080. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10081. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10082. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10083. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10084. @end example
  10085. @item interleave_top, 4
  10086. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  10087. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10088. @example
  10089. ------> time
  10090. Input:
  10091. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10092. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10093. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10094. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10095. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10096. Output:
  10097. 11111 33333
  10098. 22222 44444
  10099. 11111 33333
  10100. 22222 44444
  10101. @end example
  10102. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  10103. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  10104. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10105. @example
  10106. ------> time
  10107. Input:
  10108. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10109. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10110. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10111. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10112. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10113. Output:
  10114. 22222 44444
  10115. 11111 33333
  10116. 22222 44444
  10117. 11111 33333
  10118. @end example
  10119. @item interlacex2, 6
  10120. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  10121. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  10122. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  10123. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  10124. field synchronisation.
  10125. @example
  10126. ------> time
  10127. Input:
  10128. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10129. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10130. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10131. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10132. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10133. Output:
  10134. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  10135. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  10136. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  10137. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  10138. @end example
  10139. @item mergex2, 7
  10140. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  10141. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  10142. @example
  10143. ------> time
  10144. Input:
  10145. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10146. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10147. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10148. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10149. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10150. Output:
  10151. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10152. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10153. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10154. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10155. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10156. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10157. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10158. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10159. @end example
  10160. @end table
  10161. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  10162. compatibility reasons.
  10163. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  10164. @item flags
  10165. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  10166. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  10167. @table @option
  10168. @item low_pass_filter, vlfp
  10169. Enable vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  10170. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  10171. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  10172. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  10173. patterning.
  10174. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  10175. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  10176. @end table
  10177. @end table
  10178. @section transpose
  10179. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  10180. It accepts the following parameters:
  10181. @table @option
  10182. @item dir
  10183. Specify the transposition direction.
  10184. Can assume the following values:
  10185. @table @samp
  10186. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  10187. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  10188. @example
  10189. L.R L.l
  10190. . . -> . .
  10191. l.r R.r
  10192. @end example
  10193. @item 1, 5, clock
  10194. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  10195. @example
  10196. L.R l.L
  10197. . . -> . .
  10198. l.r r.R
  10199. @end example
  10200. @item 2, 6, cclock
  10201. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  10202. @example
  10203. L.R R.r
  10204. . . -> . .
  10205. l.r L.l
  10206. @end example
  10207. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  10208. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  10209. @example
  10210. L.R r.R
  10211. . . -> . .
  10212. l.r l.L
  10213. @end example
  10214. @end table
  10215. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  10216. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  10217. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  10218. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  10219. symbolic constants.
  10220. @item passthrough
  10221. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  10222. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  10223. @table @samp
  10224. @item none
  10225. Always apply transposition.
  10226. @item portrait
  10227. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  10228. @item landscape
  10229. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  10230. @end table
  10231. Default value is @code{none}.
  10232. @end table
  10233. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  10234. layout:
  10235. @example
  10236. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  10237. @end example
  10238. The command above can also be specified as:
  10239. @example
  10240. transpose=1:portrait
  10241. @end example
  10242. @section trim
  10243. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  10244. It accepts the following parameters:
  10245. @table @option
  10246. @item start
  10247. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  10248. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  10249. @item end
  10250. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  10251. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  10252. frame in the output.
  10253. @item start_pts
  10254. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  10255. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  10256. @item end_pts
  10257. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  10258. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  10259. @item duration
  10260. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  10261. @item start_frame
  10262. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  10263. @item end_frame
  10264. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  10265. @end table
  10266. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  10267. duration specifications; see
  10268. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  10269. for the accepted syntax.
  10270. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  10271. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  10272. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  10273. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  10274. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  10275. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  10276. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  10277. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  10278. filters.
  10279. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  10280. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  10281. Examples:
  10282. @itemize
  10283. @item
  10284. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  10285. @example
  10286. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  10287. @end example
  10288. @item
  10289. Keep only the first second:
  10290. @example
  10291. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  10292. @end example
  10293. @end itemize
  10294. @anchor{unsharp}
  10295. @section unsharp
  10296. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  10297. It accepts the following parameters:
  10298. @table @option
  10299. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  10300. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  10301. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  10302. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  10303. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  10304. and 23. The default value is 5.
  10305. @item luma_amount, la
  10306. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  10307. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  10308. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  10309. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  10310. Default value is 1.0.
  10311. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  10312. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  10313. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  10314. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  10315. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  10316. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  10317. @item chroma_amount, ca
  10318. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  10319. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  10320. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  10321. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  10322. Default value is 0.0.
  10323. @item opencl
  10324. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  10325. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  10326. @end table
  10327. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  10328. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  10329. @subsection Examples
  10330. @itemize
  10331. @item
  10332. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  10333. @example
  10334. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  10335. @end example
  10336. @item
  10337. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  10338. @example
  10339. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  10340. @end example
  10341. @end itemize
  10342. @section uspp
  10343. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  10344. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  10345. shifts and average the results.
  10346. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  10347. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  10348. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  10349. The filter accepts the following options:
  10350. @table @option
  10351. @item quality
  10352. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  10353. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  10354. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  10355. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  10356. @code{3}.
  10357. @item qp
  10358. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  10359. from the video stream (if available).
  10360. @end table
  10361. @section vaguedenoiser
  10362. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  10363. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  10364. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  10365. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  10366. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  10367. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  10368. This filter accepts the following options:
  10369. @table @option
  10370. @item threshold
  10371. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  10372. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  10373. before the video looks overfiltered.
  10374. @item method
  10375. The filtering method the filter will use.
  10376. It accepts the following values:
  10377. @table @samp
  10378. @item hard
  10379. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  10380. @item soft
  10381. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  10382. reduced by the threshold.
  10383. @item garrote
  10384. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  10385. (less) hard thresholding.
  10386. @end table
  10387. @item nsteps
  10388. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  10389. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  10390. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480)
  10391. @item percent
  10392. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100.
  10393. @item planes
  10394. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  10395. @end table
  10396. @section vectorscope
  10397. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  10398. a vectorscope).
  10399. This filter accepts the following options:
  10400. @table @option
  10401. @item mode, m
  10402. Set vectorscope mode.
  10403. It accepts the following values:
  10404. @table @samp
  10405. @item gray
  10406. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  10407. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  10408. @item color
  10409. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  10410. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  10411. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  10412. @item color2
  10413. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  10414. @item color3
  10415. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  10416. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  10417. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  10418. @item color4
  10419. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  10420. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  10421. not present in graph is picked.
  10422. @item color5
  10423. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  10424. component picked from radial gradient.
  10425. @end table
  10426. @item x
  10427. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  10428. @item y
  10429. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  10430. @item intensity, i
  10431. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  10432. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  10433. @item envelope, e
  10434. @table @samp
  10435. @item none
  10436. No envelope, this is default.
  10437. @item instant
  10438. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  10439. @item peak
  10440. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  10441. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  10442. @item peak+instant
  10443. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  10444. @end table
  10445. @item graticule, g
  10446. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  10447. @table @samp
  10448. @item none
  10449. @item green
  10450. @item color
  10451. @end table
  10452. @item opacity, o
  10453. Set graticule opacity.
  10454. @item flags, f
  10455. Set graticule flags.
  10456. @table @samp
  10457. @item white
  10458. Draw graticule for white point.
  10459. @item black
  10460. Draw graticule for black point.
  10461. @item name
  10462. Draw color points short names.
  10463. @end table
  10464. @item bgopacity, b
  10465. Set background opacity.
  10466. @item lthreshold, l
  10467. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  10468. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  10469. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  10470. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  10471. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  10472. @item hthreshold, h
  10473. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  10474. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  10475. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  10476. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  10477. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  10478. @item colorspace, c
  10479. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  10480. @table @samp
  10481. @item auto
  10482. @item 601
  10483. @item 709
  10484. @end table
  10485. Default is auto.
  10486. @end table
  10487. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  10488. @section vidstabdetect
  10489. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  10490. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  10491. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  10492. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  10493. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  10494. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10495. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  10496. This filter accepts the following options:
  10497. @table @option
  10498. @item result
  10499. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  10500. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  10501. @item shakiness
  10502. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  10503. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  10504. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  10505. @item accuracy
  10506. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  10507. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  10508. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  10509. @item stepsize
  10510. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  10511. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  10512. @item mincontrast
  10513. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  10514. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  10515. value is 0.3.
  10516. @item tripod
  10517. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  10518. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  10519. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  10520. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  10521. the camera view absolutely still.
  10522. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  10523. @item show
  10524. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  10525. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  10526. visualization.
  10527. @end table
  10528. @subsection Examples
  10529. @itemize
  10530. @item
  10531. Use default values:
  10532. @example
  10533. vidstabdetect
  10534. @end example
  10535. @item
  10536. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  10537. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  10538. @example
  10539. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  10540. @end example
  10541. @item
  10542. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  10543. video:
  10544. @example
  10545. vidstabdetect=show=1
  10546. @end example
  10547. @item
  10548. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10549. @example
  10550. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  10551. @end example
  10552. @end itemize
  10553. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  10554. @section vidstabtransform
  10555. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  10556. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  10557. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  10558. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  10559. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  10560. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  10561. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  10562. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10563. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  10564. @subsection Options
  10565. @table @option
  10566. @item input
  10567. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  10568. @file{transforms.trf}.
  10569. @item smoothing
  10570. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  10571. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  10572. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  10573. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  10574. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  10575. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  10576. camera is simulated.
  10577. @item optalgo
  10578. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  10579. Accepted values are:
  10580. @table @samp
  10581. @item gauss
  10582. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  10583. @item avg
  10584. averaging on transformations
  10585. @end table
  10586. @item maxshift
  10587. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  10588. meaning no limit.
  10589. @item maxangle
  10590. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  10591. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  10592. @item crop
  10593. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  10594. compensation.
  10595. Available values are:
  10596. @table @samp
  10597. @item keep
  10598. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  10599. @item black
  10600. fill the border black
  10601. @end table
  10602. @item invert
  10603. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  10604. @item relative
  10605. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  10606. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  10607. @item zoom
  10608. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  10609. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  10610. zoom).
  10611. @item optzoom
  10612. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  10613. Accepted values are:
  10614. @table @samp
  10615. @item 0
  10616. disabled
  10617. @item 1
  10618. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  10619. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  10620. @item 2
  10621. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  10622. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  10623. @end table
  10624. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  10625. @item zoomspeed
  10626. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  10627. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  10628. 0.25.
  10629. @item interpol
  10630. Specify type of interpolation.
  10631. Available values are:
  10632. @table @samp
  10633. @item no
  10634. no interpolation
  10635. @item linear
  10636. linear only horizontal
  10637. @item bilinear
  10638. linear in both directions (default)
  10639. @item bicubic
  10640. cubic in both directions (slow)
  10641. @end table
  10642. @item tripod
  10643. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  10644. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  10645. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  10646. @item debug
  10647. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  10648. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  10649. value is 0.
  10650. @end table
  10651. @subsection Examples
  10652. @itemize
  10653. @item
  10654. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  10655. @example
  10656. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  10657. @end example
  10658. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  10659. @item
  10660. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  10661. @example
  10662. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  10663. @end example
  10664. @item
  10665. Smoothen the video even more:
  10666. @example
  10667. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  10668. @end example
  10669. @end itemize
  10670. @section vflip
  10671. Flip the input video vertically.
  10672. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  10673. @example
  10674. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  10675. @end example
  10676. @anchor{vignette}
  10677. @section vignette
  10678. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  10679. The filter accepts the following options:
  10680. @table @option
  10681. @item angle, a
  10682. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  10683. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  10684. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  10685. @item x0
  10686. @item y0
  10687. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  10688. by default.
  10689. @item mode
  10690. Set forward/backward mode.
  10691. Available modes are:
  10692. @table @samp
  10693. @item forward
  10694. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  10695. @item backward
  10696. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  10697. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  10698. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  10699. also be used to create a burning effect.
  10700. @end table
  10701. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  10702. @item eval
  10703. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  10704. It accepts the following values:
  10705. @table @samp
  10706. @item init
  10707. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  10708. @item frame
  10709. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  10710. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  10711. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  10712. @end table
  10713. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10714. @item dither
  10715. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  10716. (enabled).
  10717. @item aspect
  10718. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  10719. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  10720. following the dimensions of the video.
  10721. Default is @code{1/1}.
  10722. @end table
  10723. @subsection Expressions
  10724. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  10725. following parameters.
  10726. @table @option
  10727. @item w
  10728. @item h
  10729. input width and height
  10730. @item n
  10731. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10732. @item pts
  10733. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  10734. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  10735. @item r
  10736. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  10737. @item t
  10738. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  10739. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  10740. @item tb
  10741. time base of the input video
  10742. @end table
  10743. @subsection Examples
  10744. @itemize
  10745. @item
  10746. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  10747. @example
  10748. vignette=PI/4
  10749. @end example
  10750. @item
  10751. Make a flickering vignetting:
  10752. @example
  10753. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  10754. @end example
  10755. @end itemize
  10756. @section vstack
  10757. Stack input videos vertically.
  10758. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  10759. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  10760. to create same output.
  10761. The filter accept the following option:
  10762. @table @option
  10763. @item inputs
  10764. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  10765. @item shortest
  10766. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  10767. terminates. Default value is 0.
  10768. @end table
  10769. @section w3fdif
  10770. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  10771. Deinterlacing Filter").
  10772. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  10773. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  10774. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  10775. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  10776. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple":
  10777. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  10778. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  10779. @table @option
  10780. @item filter
  10781. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  10782. @table @samp
  10783. @item simple
  10784. Simple filter coefficient set.
  10785. @item complex
  10786. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  10787. @end table
  10788. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  10789. @item deint
  10790. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following values:
  10791. @table @samp
  10792. @item all
  10793. Deinterlace all frames,
  10794. @item interlaced
  10795. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  10796. @end table
  10797. Default value is @samp{all}.
  10798. @end table
  10799. @section waveform
  10800. Video waveform monitor.
  10801. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  10802. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  10803. source video.
  10804. It accepts the following options:
  10805. @table @option
  10806. @item mode, m
  10807. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  10808. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  10809. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  10810. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  10811. @item intensity, i
  10812. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  10813. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  10814. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  10815. @item mirror, r
  10816. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  10817. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  10818. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  10819. @code{1} (mirrored).
  10820. @item display, d
  10821. Set display mode.
  10822. It accepts the following values:
  10823. @table @samp
  10824. @item overlay
  10825. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  10826. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  10827. over one another.
  10828. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  10829. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  10830. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  10831. @item stack
  10832. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  10833. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  10834. @item parade
  10835. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  10836. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  10837. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  10838. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  10839. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  10840. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  10841. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  10842. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  10843. @end table
  10844. Default is @code{stack}.
  10845. @item components, c
  10846. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  10847. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  10848. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  10849. @item envelope, e
  10850. @table @samp
  10851. @item none
  10852. No envelope, this is default.
  10853. @item instant
  10854. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  10855. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  10856. @item peak
  10857. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  10858. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  10859. @item peak+instant
  10860. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  10861. @end table
  10862. @item filter, f
  10863. @table @samp
  10864. @item lowpass
  10865. No filtering, this is default.
  10866. @item flat
  10867. Luma and chroma combined together.
  10868. @item aflat
  10869. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  10870. @item chroma
  10871. Displays only chroma.
  10872. @item color
  10873. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  10874. @item acolor
  10875. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  10876. @end table
  10877. @item graticule, g
  10878. Set which graticule to display.
  10879. @table @samp
  10880. @item none
  10881. Do not display graticule.
  10882. @item green
  10883. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  10884. @end table
  10885. @item opacity, o
  10886. Set graticule opacity.
  10887. @item flags, fl
  10888. Set graticule flags.
  10889. @table @samp
  10890. @item numbers
  10891. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  10892. @item dots
  10893. Draw dots instead of lines.
  10894. @end table
  10895. @item scale, s
  10896. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  10897. @table @samp
  10898. @item digital
  10899. @item millivolts
  10900. @item ire
  10901. @end table
  10902. Default is digital.
  10903. @item bgopacity, b
  10904. Set background opacity.
  10905. @end table
  10906. @section weave
  10907. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  10908. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  10909. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  10910. It accepts the following option:
  10911. @table @option
  10912. @item first_field
  10913. Set first field. Available values are:
  10914. @table @samp
  10915. @item top, t
  10916. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  10917. @item bottom, b
  10918. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  10919. @end table
  10920. @end table
  10921. @subsection Examples
  10922. @itemize
  10923. @item
  10924. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  10925. @example
  10926. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  10927. @end example
  10928. @end itemize
  10929. @section xbr
  10930. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  10931. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  10932. @url{http://www.libretro.com/forums/viewtopic.php?f=6&t=134}.
  10933. It accepts the following option:
  10934. @table @option
  10935. @item n
  10936. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  10937. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  10938. Default is @code{3}.
  10939. @end table
  10940. @anchor{yadif}
  10941. @section yadif
  10942. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  10943. filter").
  10944. It accepts the following parameters:
  10945. @table @option
  10946. @item mode
  10947. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  10948. @table @option
  10949. @item 0, send_frame
  10950. Output one frame for each frame.
  10951. @item 1, send_field
  10952. Output one frame for each field.
  10953. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  10954. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10955. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  10956. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10957. @end table
  10958. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  10959. @item parity
  10960. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  10961. of the following values:
  10962. @table @option
  10963. @item 0, tff
  10964. Assume the top field is first.
  10965. @item 1, bff
  10966. Assume the bottom field is first.
  10967. @item -1, auto
  10968. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  10969. @end table
  10970. The default value is @code{auto}.
  10971. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  10972. top field first will be assumed.
  10973. @item deint
  10974. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  10975. values:
  10976. @table @option
  10977. @item 0, all
  10978. Deinterlace all frames.
  10979. @item 1, interlaced
  10980. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  10981. @end table
  10982. The default value is @code{all}.
  10983. @end table
  10984. @section zoompan
  10985. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  10986. This filter accepts the following options:
  10987. @table @option
  10988. @item zoom, z
  10989. Set the zoom expression. Default is 1.
  10990. @item x
  10991. @item y
  10992. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  10993. @item d
  10994. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  10995. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  10996. single input image.
  10997. @item s
  10998. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  10999. @item fps
  11000. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  11001. @end table
  11002. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  11003. @table @option
  11004. @item in_w, iw
  11005. Input width.
  11006. @item in_h, ih
  11007. Input height.
  11008. @item out_w, ow
  11009. Output width.
  11010. @item out_h, oh
  11011. Output height.
  11012. @item in
  11013. Input frame count.
  11014. @item on
  11015. Output frame count.
  11016. @item x
  11017. @item y
  11018. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  11019. for current input frame.
  11020. @item px
  11021. @item py
  11022. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  11023. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  11024. @item zoom
  11025. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  11026. @item pzoom
  11027. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  11028. @item duration
  11029. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  11030. for each input frame.
  11031. @item pduration
  11032. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  11033. @item a
  11034. Rational number: input width / input height
  11035. @item sar
  11036. sample aspect ratio
  11037. @item dar
  11038. display aspect ratio
  11039. @end table
  11040. @subsection Examples
  11041. @itemize
  11042. @item
  11043. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  11044. @example
  11045. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  11046. @end example
  11047. @item
  11048. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  11049. @example
  11050. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  11051. @end example
  11052. @item
  11053. Same as above but without pausing:
  11054. @example
  11055. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  11056. @end example
  11057. @end itemize
  11058. @section zscale
  11059. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  11060. https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg.
  11061. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  11062. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  11063. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  11064. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  11065. requested format.
  11066. @subsection Options
  11067. The filter accepts the following options.
  11068. @table @option
  11069. @item width, w
  11070. @item height, h
  11071. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  11072. dimension.
  11073. If the @var{width} or @var{w} is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  11074. If the @var{height} or @var{h} is 0, the input height is used for the output.
  11075. If one of the values is -1, the zscale filter will use a value that
  11076. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  11077. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  11078. used
  11079. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the zscale filter will also use a value
  11080. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  11081. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  11082. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  11083. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  11084. expression.
  11085. @item size, s
  11086. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11087. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11088. @item dither, d
  11089. Set the dither type.
  11090. Possible values are:
  11091. @table @var
  11092. @item none
  11093. @item ordered
  11094. @item random
  11095. @item error_diffusion
  11096. @end table
  11097. Default is none.
  11098. @item filter, f
  11099. Set the resize filter type.
  11100. Possible values are:
  11101. @table @var
  11102. @item point
  11103. @item bilinear
  11104. @item bicubic
  11105. @item spline16
  11106. @item spline36
  11107. @item lanczos
  11108. @end table
  11109. Default is bilinear.
  11110. @item range, r
  11111. Set the color range.
  11112. Possible values are:
  11113. @table @var
  11114. @item input
  11115. @item limited
  11116. @item full
  11117. @end table
  11118. Default is same as input.
  11119. @item primaries, p
  11120. Set the color primaries.
  11121. Possible values are:
  11122. @table @var
  11123. @item input
  11124. @item 709
  11125. @item unspecified
  11126. @item 170m
  11127. @item 240m
  11128. @item 2020
  11129. @end table
  11130. Default is same as input.
  11131. @item transfer, t
  11132. Set the transfer characteristics.
  11133. Possible values are:
  11134. @table @var
  11135. @item input
  11136. @item 709
  11137. @item unspecified
  11138. @item 601
  11139. @item linear
  11140. @item 2020_10
  11141. @item 2020_12
  11142. @end table
  11143. Default is same as input.
  11144. @item matrix, m
  11145. Set the colorspace matrix.
  11146. Possible value are:
  11147. @table @var
  11148. @item input
  11149. @item 709
  11150. @item unspecified
  11151. @item 470bg
  11152. @item 170m
  11153. @item 2020_ncl
  11154. @item 2020_cl
  11155. @end table
  11156. Default is same as input.
  11157. @item rangein, rin
  11158. Set the input color range.
  11159. Possible values are:
  11160. @table @var
  11161. @item input
  11162. @item limited
  11163. @item full
  11164. @end table
  11165. Default is same as input.
  11166. @item primariesin, pin
  11167. Set the input color primaries.
  11168. Possible values are:
  11169. @table @var
  11170. @item input
  11171. @item 709
  11172. @item unspecified
  11173. @item 170m
  11174. @item 240m
  11175. @item 2020
  11176. @end table
  11177. Default is same as input.
  11178. @item transferin, tin
  11179. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  11180. Possible values are:
  11181. @table @var
  11182. @item input
  11183. @item 709
  11184. @item unspecified
  11185. @item 601
  11186. @item linear
  11187. @item 2020_10
  11188. @item 2020_12
  11189. @end table
  11190. Default is same as input.
  11191. @item matrixin, min
  11192. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  11193. Possible value are:
  11194. @table @var
  11195. @item input
  11196. @item 709
  11197. @item unspecified
  11198. @item 470bg
  11199. @item 170m
  11200. @item 2020_ncl
  11201. @item 2020_cl
  11202. @end table
  11203. @item chromal, c
  11204. Set the output chroma location.
  11205. Possible values are:
  11206. @table @var
  11207. @item input
  11208. @item left
  11209. @item center
  11210. @item topleft
  11211. @item top
  11212. @item bottomleft
  11213. @item bottom
  11214. @end table
  11215. @item chromalin, cin
  11216. Set the input chroma location.
  11217. Possible values are:
  11218. @table @var
  11219. @item input
  11220. @item left
  11221. @item center
  11222. @item topleft
  11223. @item top
  11224. @item bottomleft
  11225. @item bottom
  11226. @end table
  11227. @end table
  11228. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  11229. containing the following constants:
  11230. @table @var
  11231. @item in_w
  11232. @item in_h
  11233. The input width and height
  11234. @item iw
  11235. @item ih
  11236. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11237. @item out_w
  11238. @item out_h
  11239. The output (scaled) width and height
  11240. @item ow
  11241. @item oh
  11242. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  11243. @item a
  11244. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11245. @item sar
  11246. input sample aspect ratio
  11247. @item dar
  11248. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  11249. @item hsub
  11250. @item vsub
  11251. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11252. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11253. @item ohsub
  11254. @item ovsub
  11255. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11256. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11257. @end table
  11258. @table @option
  11259. @end table
  11260. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  11261. @chapter Video Sources
  11262. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  11263. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  11264. @section buffer
  11265. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  11266. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  11267. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  11268. It accepts the following parameters:
  11269. @table @option
  11270. @item video_size
  11271. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  11272. syntax of this option, check the
  11273. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11274. @item width
  11275. The input video width.
  11276. @item height
  11277. The input video height.
  11278. @item pix_fmt
  11279. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  11280. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  11281. name.
  11282. @item time_base
  11283. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  11284. @item frame_rate
  11285. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  11286. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  11287. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  11288. @item sws_param
  11289. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  11290. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  11291. input size or format.
  11292. @item hw_frames_ctx
  11293. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  11294. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  11295. @end table
  11296. For example:
  11297. @example
  11298. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  11299. @end example
  11300. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  11301. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  11302. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  11303. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  11304. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  11305. this example corresponds to:
  11306. @example
  11307. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  11308. @end example
  11309. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  11310. syntax is deprecated:
  11311. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  11312. @section cellauto
  11313. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  11314. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  11315. @option{filename}, and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  11316. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  11317. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  11318. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  11319. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  11320. This source accepts the following options:
  11321. @table @option
  11322. @item filename, f
  11323. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  11324. the specified file.
  11325. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  11326. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  11327. file will be ignored.
  11328. @item pattern, p
  11329. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  11330. the specified string.
  11331. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  11332. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  11333. string will be ignored.
  11334. @item rate, r
  11335. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  11336. Default is 25.
  11337. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  11338. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  11339. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  11340. 1/PHI.
  11341. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  11342. @item random_seed, seed
  11343. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  11344. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  11345. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  11346. effort basis.
  11347. @item rule
  11348. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  11349. Default value is 110.
  11350. @item size, s
  11351. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11352. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11353. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  11354. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  11355. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  11356. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  11357. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  11358. larger row.
  11359. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  11360. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  11361. @item scroll
  11362. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  11363. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  11364. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  11365. Defaults to 1.
  11366. @item start_full, full
  11367. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  11368. outputting the first frame.
  11369. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  11370. @item stitch
  11371. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  11372. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  11373. @end table
  11374. @subsection Examples
  11375. @itemize
  11376. @item
  11377. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  11378. size 200x400.
  11379. @example
  11380. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  11381. @end example
  11382. @item
  11383. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  11384. ratio of 2/3:
  11385. @example
  11386. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  11387. @end example
  11388. @item
  11389. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  11390. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  11391. @example
  11392. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  11393. @end example
  11394. @item
  11395. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  11396. @example
  11397. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  11398. @end example
  11399. @end itemize
  11400. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  11401. @section coreimagesrc
  11402. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  11403. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  11404. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  11405. generate the content.
  11406. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  11407. @table @option
  11408. @item list_generators
  11409. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  11410. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  11411. @example
  11412. list_generators=true
  11413. @end example
  11414. @item size, s
  11415. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11416. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11417. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  11418. @item rate, r
  11419. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11420. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11421. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11422. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11423. "25".
  11424. @item sar
  11425. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  11426. @item duration, d
  11427. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11428. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11429. for the accepted syntax.
  11430. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11431. supposed to be generated forever.
  11432. @end table
  11433. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  11434. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  11435. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  11436. and examples for details.
  11437. @subsection Examples
  11438. @itemize
  11439. @item
  11440. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  11441. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  11442. @example
  11443. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  11444. @end example
  11445. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  11446. need for a nullsrc video source.
  11447. @end itemize
  11448. @section mandelbrot
  11449. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  11450. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  11451. This source accepts the following options:
  11452. @table @option
  11453. @item end_pts
  11454. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  11455. @item end_scale
  11456. Set the terminal scale value.
  11457. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  11458. @item inner
  11459. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  11460. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  11461. It shall assume one of the following values:
  11462. @table @option
  11463. @item black
  11464. Set black mode.
  11465. @item convergence
  11466. Show time until convergence.
  11467. @item mincol
  11468. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  11469. @item period
  11470. Set period mode.
  11471. @end table
  11472. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  11473. @item bailout
  11474. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  11475. @item maxiter
  11476. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  11477. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  11478. @item outer
  11479. Set outer coloring mode.
  11480. It shall assume one of following values:
  11481. @table @option
  11482. @item iteration_count
  11483. Set iteration cound mode.
  11484. @item normalized_iteration_count
  11485. set normalized iteration count mode.
  11486. @end table
  11487. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  11488. @item rate, r
  11489. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  11490. value is "25".
  11491. @item size, s
  11492. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
  11493. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default value is "640x480".
  11494. @item start_scale
  11495. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  11496. @item start_x
  11497. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  11498. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  11499. @item start_y
  11500. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  11501. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  11502. @end table
  11503. @section mptestsrc
  11504. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  11505. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  11506. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  11507. This source accepts the following options:
  11508. @table @option
  11509. @item rate, r
  11510. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11511. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11512. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11513. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11514. "25".
  11515. @item duration, d
  11516. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11517. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11518. for the accepted syntax.
  11519. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11520. supposed to be generated forever.
  11521. @item test, t
  11522. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  11523. @table @option
  11524. @item dc_luma
  11525. @item dc_chroma
  11526. @item freq_luma
  11527. @item freq_chroma
  11528. @item amp_luma
  11529. @item amp_chroma
  11530. @item cbp
  11531. @item mv
  11532. @item ring1
  11533. @item ring2
  11534. @item all
  11535. @end table
  11536. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  11537. @end table
  11538. Some examples:
  11539. @example
  11540. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  11541. @end example
  11542. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  11543. @section frei0r_src
  11544. Provide a frei0r source.
  11545. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  11546. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  11547. This source accepts the following parameters:
  11548. @table @option
  11549. @item size
  11550. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11551. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11552. @item framerate
  11553. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  11554. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  11555. @item filter_name
  11556. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  11557. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  11558. documentation.
  11559. @item filter_params
  11560. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  11561. @end table
  11562. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  11563. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  11564. @example
  11565. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  11566. @end example
  11567. @section life
  11568. Generate a life pattern.
  11569. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  11570. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  11571. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  11572. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  11573. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  11574. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  11575. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  11576. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  11577. the rule to adopt.
  11578. This source accepts the following options:
  11579. @table @option
  11580. @item filename, f
  11581. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  11582. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  11583. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  11584. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  11585. randomly.
  11586. @item rate, r
  11587. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  11588. Default is 25.
  11589. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  11590. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  11591. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  11592. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  11593. @item random_seed, seed
  11594. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  11595. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  11596. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  11597. effort basis.
  11598. @item rule
  11599. Set the life rule.
  11600. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  11601. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  11602. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  11603. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  11604. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  11605. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  11606. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  11607. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  11608. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  11609. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  11610. higher number of neighbor cells.
  11611. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  11612. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  11613. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  11614. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  11615. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  11616. a dead cell.
  11617. @item size, s
  11618. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11619. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11620. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  11621. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  11622. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  11623. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  11624. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  11625. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  11626. @item stitch
  11627. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  11628. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  11629. @item mold
  11630. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  11631. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  11632. value from 0 to 255.
  11633. @item life_color
  11634. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  11635. @item death_color
  11636. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  11637. used to represent a dead cell.
  11638. @item mold_color
  11639. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  11640. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the
  11641. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  11642. @end table
  11643. @subsection Examples
  11644. @itemize
  11645. @item
  11646. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  11647. 300x300 pixels:
  11648. @example
  11649. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  11650. @end example
  11651. @item
  11652. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  11653. @example
  11654. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  11655. @end example
  11656. @item
  11657. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  11658. @example
  11659. life=rule=S14/B34
  11660. @end example
  11661. @item
  11662. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  11663. @example
  11664. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  11665. @end example
  11666. @end itemize
  11667. @anchor{allrgb}
  11668. @anchor{allyuv}
  11669. @anchor{color}
  11670. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  11671. @anchor{nullsrc}
  11672. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  11673. @anchor{smptebars}
  11674. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  11675. @anchor{testsrc}
  11676. @anchor{testsrc2}
  11677. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  11678. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  11679. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  11680. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  11681. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  11682. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  11683. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  11684. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  11685. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  11686. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  11687. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  11688. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  11689. stripe from top to bottom.
  11690. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  11691. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  11692. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  11693. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  11694. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  11695. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  11696. intended for testing purposes.
  11697. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  11698. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  11699. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  11700. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  11701. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  11702. The sources accept the following parameters:
  11703. @table @option
  11704. @item color, c
  11705. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  11706. source. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  11707. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  11708. @item level
  11709. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  11710. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  11711. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  11712. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  11713. @item size, s
  11714. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11715. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11716. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  11717. This option is not available with the @code{haldclutsrc} filter.
  11718. @item rate, r
  11719. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11720. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11721. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11722. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11723. "25".
  11724. @item sar
  11725. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  11726. @item duration, d
  11727. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11728. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11729. for the accepted syntax.
  11730. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11731. supposed to be generated forever.
  11732. @item decimals, n
  11733. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  11734. @code{testsrc} source.
  11735. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  11736. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  11737. value. Default value is 0.
  11738. @end table
  11739. For example the following:
  11740. @example
  11741. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  11742. @end example
  11743. will generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  11744. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second.
  11745. The following graph description will generate a red source
  11746. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  11747. frames per second.
  11748. @example
  11749. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  11750. @end example
  11751. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  11752. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  11753. the @code{geq} filter:
  11754. @example
  11755. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  11756. @end example
  11757. @subsection Commands
  11758. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  11759. @table @option
  11760. @item c, color
  11761. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  11762. corresponding @option{color} option.
  11763. @end table
  11764. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  11765. @chapter Video Sinks
  11766. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  11767. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  11768. @section buffersink
  11769. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  11770. graph.
  11771. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  11772. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  11773. or the options system.
  11774. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  11775. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  11776. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  11777. @section nullsink
  11778. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  11779. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  11780. tools.
  11781. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  11782. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  11783. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  11784. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  11785. @section ahistogram
  11786. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  11787. The filter accepts the following options:
  11788. @table @option
  11789. @item dmode
  11790. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  11791. It accepts the following values:
  11792. @table @samp
  11793. @item single
  11794. Use single histogram for all channels.
  11795. @item separate
  11796. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  11797. @end table
  11798. Default is @code{single}.
  11799. @item rate, r
  11800. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  11801. value is "25".
  11802. @item size, s
  11803. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11804. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11805. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  11806. @item scale
  11807. Set display scale.
  11808. It accepts the following values:
  11809. @table @samp
  11810. @item log
  11811. logarithmic
  11812. @item sqrt
  11813. square root
  11814. @item cbrt
  11815. cubic root
  11816. @item lin
  11817. linear
  11818. @item rlog
  11819. reverse logarithmic
  11820. @end table
  11821. Default is @code{log}.
  11822. @item ascale
  11823. Set amplitude scale.
  11824. It accepts the following values:
  11825. @table @samp
  11826. @item log
  11827. logarithmic
  11828. @item lin
  11829. linear
  11830. @end table
  11831. Default is @code{log}.
  11832. @item acount
  11833. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  11834. Defauls is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  11835. @item rheight
  11836. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  11837. @item slide
  11838. Set sonogram sliding.
  11839. It accepts the following values:
  11840. @table @samp
  11841. @item replace
  11842. replace old rows with new ones.
  11843. @item scroll
  11844. scroll from top to bottom.
  11845. @end table
  11846. Default is @code{replace}.
  11847. @end table
  11848. @section aphasemeter
  11849. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio phase.
  11850. The filter accepts the following options:
  11851. @table @option
  11852. @item rate, r
  11853. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  11854. @item size, s
  11855. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11856. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11857. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  11858. @item rc
  11859. @item gc
  11860. @item bc
  11861. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  11862. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  11863. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11864. @item mpc
  11865. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  11866. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  11867. @end table
  11868. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase} which
  11869. represents mean phase of current audio frame. Value is in range @code{[-1, 1]}.
  11870. The @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase and
  11871. @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  11872. @section avectorscope
  11873. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  11874. scope.
  11875. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  11876. audio stream. A monoaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  11877. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  11878. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  11879. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  11880. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  11881. The filter accepts the following options:
  11882. @table @option
  11883. @item mode, m
  11884. Set the vectorscope mode.
  11885. Available values are:
  11886. @table @samp
  11887. @item lissajous
  11888. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  11889. @item lissajous_xy
  11890. Same as above but not rotated.
  11891. @item polar
  11892. Shape resembling half of circle.
  11893. @end table
  11894. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  11895. @item size, s
  11896. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11897. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11898. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  11899. @item rate, r
  11900. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  11901. @item rc
  11902. @item gc
  11903. @item bc
  11904. @item ac
  11905. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  11906. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  11907. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11908. @item rf
  11909. @item gf
  11910. @item bf
  11911. @item af
  11912. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  11913. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  11914. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11915. @item zoom
  11916. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[1, 10]}.
  11917. @item draw
  11918. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  11919. Available values are:
  11920. @table @samp
  11921. @item dot
  11922. Draw dot for each sample.
  11923. @item line
  11924. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  11925. @end table
  11926. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  11927. @item scale
  11928. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  11929. Available values are:
  11930. @table @samp
  11931. @item lin
  11932. Linear.
  11933. @item sqrt
  11934. Square root.
  11935. @item cbrt
  11936. Cubic root.
  11937. @item log
  11938. Logarithmic.
  11939. @end table
  11940. @end table
  11941. @subsection Examples
  11942. @itemize
  11943. @item
  11944. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  11945. @example
  11946. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  11947. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  11948. @end example
  11949. @end itemize
  11950. @section bench, abench
  11951. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  11952. The filter accepts the following options:
  11953. @table @option
  11954. @item action
  11955. Start or stop a timer.
  11956. Available values are:
  11957. @table @samp
  11958. @item start
  11959. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  11960. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  11961. @item stop
  11962. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  11963. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  11964. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  11965. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  11966. @end table
  11967. @end table
  11968. @subsection Examples
  11969. @itemize
  11970. @item
  11971. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  11972. @example
  11973. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  11974. @end example
  11975. @end itemize
  11976. @section concat
  11977. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  11978. other.
  11979. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  11980. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  11981. also be the number of streams at output.
  11982. The filter accepts the following options:
  11983. @table @option
  11984. @item n
  11985. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  11986. @item v
  11987. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  11988. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  11989. @item a
  11990. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  11991. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  11992. @item unsafe
  11993. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  11994. @end table
  11995. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  11996. @var{a} audio outputs.
  11997. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  11998. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  11999. segment, etc.
  12000. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  12001. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  12002. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  12003. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  12004. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  12005. audio streams with silence.
  12006. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  12007. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  12008. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  12009. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  12010. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  12011. explicitly by the user.
  12012. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  12013. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  12014. @subsection Examples
  12015. @itemize
  12016. @item
  12017. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  12018. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  12019. @example
  12020. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  12021. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  12022. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  12023. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  12024. @end example
  12025. @item
  12026. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  12027. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  12028. @example
  12029. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  12030. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  12031. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  12032. @end example
  12033. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  12034. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  12035. @end itemize
  12036. @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
  12037. Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
  12038. It accepts the following parameters:
  12039. @table @option
  12040. @item m1
  12041. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12042. @item fg1
  12043. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  12044. @item m2
  12045. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12046. @item fg2
  12047. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  12048. @item m3
  12049. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12050. @item fg3
  12051. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  12052. @item m4
  12053. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12054. @item fg4
  12055. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  12056. @item min
  12057. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  12058. @item max
  12059. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  12060. @item bg
  12061. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  12062. @item mode
  12063. Set graph mode.
  12064. Available values for mode is:
  12065. @table @samp
  12066. @item bar
  12067. @item dot
  12068. @item line
  12069. @end table
  12070. Default is @code{line}.
  12071. @item slide
  12072. Set slide mode.
  12073. Available values for slide is:
  12074. @table @samp
  12075. @item frame
  12076. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  12077. @item replace
  12078. Replace old columns with new ones.
  12079. @item scroll
  12080. Scroll from right to left.
  12081. @item rscroll
  12082. Scroll from left to right.
  12083. @item picture
  12084. Draw single picture.
  12085. @end table
  12086. Default is @code{frame}.
  12087. @item size
  12088. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12089. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12090. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  12091. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  12092. @table @option
  12093. @item MIN
  12094. Minimal value of metadata value.
  12095. @item MAX
  12096. Maximal value of metadata value.
  12097. @item VAL
  12098. Current metadata key value.
  12099. @end table
  12100. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  12101. @end table
  12102. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  12103. @example
  12104. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  12105. @end example
  12106. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  12107. @example
  12108. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  12109. @end example
  12110. @anchor{ebur128}
  12111. @section ebur128
  12112. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as input and outputs
  12113. it unchanged. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  12114. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  12115. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  12116. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  12117. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  12118. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  12119. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  12120. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  12121. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds).
  12122. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  12123. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  12124. The filter accepts the following options:
  12125. @table @option
  12126. @item video
  12127. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  12128. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  12129. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  12130. @item size
  12131. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  12132. option, check the
  12133. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12134. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  12135. @item meter
  12136. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  12137. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  12138. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  12139. @item metadata
  12140. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  12141. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  12142. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  12143. Default is @code{0}.
  12144. @item framelog
  12145. Force the frame logging level.
  12146. Available values are:
  12147. @table @samp
  12148. @item info
  12149. information logging level
  12150. @item verbose
  12151. verbose logging level
  12152. @end table
  12153. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  12154. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  12155. @item peak
  12156. Set peak mode(s).
  12157. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  12158. values are:
  12159. @table @samp
  12160. @item none
  12161. Disable any peak mode (default).
  12162. @item sample
  12163. Enable sample-peak mode.
  12164. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  12165. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  12166. @item true
  12167. Enable true-peak mode.
  12168. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  12169. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  12170. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  12171. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  12172. @end table
  12173. @item dualmono
  12174. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  12175. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  12176. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  12177. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  12178. @item panlaw
  12179. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  12180. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  12181. @end table
  12182. @subsection Examples
  12183. @itemize
  12184. @item
  12185. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  12186. @example
  12187. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  12188. @end example
  12189. @item
  12190. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  12191. @example
  12192. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  12193. @end example
  12194. @end itemize
  12195. @section interleave, ainterleave
  12196. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  12197. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  12198. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  12199. queued frame to the output.
  12200. Input streams must have a well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  12201. timestamp values.
  12202. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  12203. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  12204. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  12205. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  12206. which always drop input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  12207. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  12208. to output until the input will send an end-of-stream signal.
  12209. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  12210. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  12211. the queue is already filled.
  12212. These filters accept the following options:
  12213. @table @option
  12214. @item nb_inputs, n
  12215. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  12216. @end table
  12217. @subsection Examples
  12218. @itemize
  12219. @item
  12220. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  12221. @example
  12222. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  12223. @end example
  12224. @item
  12225. Add flickering blur effect:
  12226. @example
  12227. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  12228. @end example
  12229. @end itemize
  12230. @section metadata, ametadata
  12231. Manipulate frame metadata.
  12232. This filter accepts the following options:
  12233. @table @option
  12234. @item mode
  12235. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  12236. Can be one of the following:
  12237. @table @samp
  12238. @item select
  12239. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  12240. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  12241. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  12242. @item add
  12243. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  12244. do nothing.
  12245. @item modify
  12246. Modify value of already present key.
  12247. @item delete
  12248. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  12249. Otherwise, delete key.
  12250. @item print
  12251. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  12252. metadata values available in frame.
  12253. @end table
  12254. @item key
  12255. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print}.
  12256. @item value
  12257. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  12258. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  12259. @item function
  12260. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  12261. Can be one of following:
  12262. @table @samp
  12263. @item same_str
  12264. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  12265. @item starts_with
  12266. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  12267. the @code{value} option string.
  12268. @item less
  12269. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  12270. @item equal
  12271. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  12272. @item greater
  12273. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  12274. @item expr
  12275. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  12276. evaluates to true.
  12277. @end table
  12278. @item expr
  12279. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  12280. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  12281. constants:
  12282. @table @option
  12283. @item VALUE1
  12284. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  12285. @item VALUE2
  12286. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  12287. @item file
  12288. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  12289. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  12290. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  12291. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  12292. @end table
  12293. @end table
  12294. @subsection Examples
  12295. @itemize
  12296. @item
  12297. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.singnalstats.YDIF} with values
  12298. between 0 and 1.
  12299. @example
  12300. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  12301. @end example
  12302. @item
  12303. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  12304. @example
  12305. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  12306. @end example
  12307. @item
  12308. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  12309. @example
  12310. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  12311. @end example
  12312. @end itemize
  12313. @section perms, aperms
  12314. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  12315. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  12316. following filter in the filtergraph.
  12317. The filters accept the following options:
  12318. @table @option
  12319. @item mode
  12320. Select the permissions mode.
  12321. It accepts the following values:
  12322. @table @samp
  12323. @item none
  12324. Do nothing. This is the default.
  12325. @item ro
  12326. Set all the output frames read-only.
  12327. @item rw
  12328. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  12329. @item toggle
  12330. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  12331. @item random
  12332. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  12333. @end table
  12334. @item seed
  12335. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  12336. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  12337. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  12338. basis.
  12339. @end table
  12340. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  12341. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  12342. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  12343. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  12344. @section realtime, arealtime
  12345. Slow down filtering to match real time approximatively.
  12346. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  12347. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  12348. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  12349. They accept the following options:
  12350. @table @option
  12351. @item limit
  12352. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  12353. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  12354. @end table
  12355. @anchor{select}
  12356. @section select, aselect
  12357. Select frames to pass in output.
  12358. This filter accepts the following options:
  12359. @table @option
  12360. @item expr, e
  12361. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  12362. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  12363. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  12364. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  12365. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  12366. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  12367. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  12368. @item outputs, n
  12369. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  12370. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  12371. @end table
  12372. The expression can contain the following constants:
  12373. @table @option
  12374. @item n
  12375. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  12376. @item selected_n
  12377. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  12378. @item prev_selected_n
  12379. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12380. @item TB
  12381. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  12382. @item pts
  12383. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  12384. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  12385. @item t
  12386. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  12387. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  12388. @item prev_pts
  12389. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12390. @item prev_selected_pts
  12391. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12392. @item prev_selected_t
  12393. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12394. @item start_pts
  12395. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  12396. @item start_t
  12397. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  12398. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  12399. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  12400. values:
  12401. @table @option
  12402. @item I
  12403. @item P
  12404. @item B
  12405. @item S
  12406. @item SI
  12407. @item SP
  12408. @item BI
  12409. @end table
  12410. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  12411. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  12412. @table @option
  12413. @item PROGRESSIVE
  12414. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  12415. @item TOPFIRST
  12416. The frame is top-field-first.
  12417. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  12418. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  12419. @end table
  12420. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  12421. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  12422. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  12423. the number of samples in the current frame
  12424. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  12425. the input sample rate
  12426. @item key
  12427. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  12428. @item pos
  12429. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  12430. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  12431. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  12432. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  12433. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  12434. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  12435. @item concatdec_select
  12436. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  12437. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  12438. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  12439. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  12440. interval.
  12441. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  12442. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  12443. present in the decoded frames.
  12444. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  12445. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  12446. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  12447. missing.
  12448. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  12449. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  12450. @end table
  12451. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  12452. @subsection Examples
  12453. @itemize
  12454. @item
  12455. Select all frames in input:
  12456. @example
  12457. select
  12458. @end example
  12459. The example above is the same as:
  12460. @example
  12461. select=1
  12462. @end example
  12463. @item
  12464. Skip all frames:
  12465. @example
  12466. select=0
  12467. @end example
  12468. @item
  12469. Select only I-frames:
  12470. @example
  12471. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  12472. @end example
  12473. @item
  12474. Select one frame every 100:
  12475. @example
  12476. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  12477. @end example
  12478. @item
  12479. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  12480. @example
  12481. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  12482. @end example
  12483. @item
  12484. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  12485. @example
  12486. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  12487. @end example
  12488. @item
  12489. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  12490. @example
  12491. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  12492. @end example
  12493. @item
  12494. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  12495. @example
  12496. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  12497. @end example
  12498. @item
  12499. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  12500. @example
  12501. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  12502. @end example
  12503. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  12504. choice.
  12505. @item
  12506. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  12507. @example
  12508. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  12509. @end example
  12510. @item
  12511. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  12512. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  12513. @example
  12514. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  12515. @end example
  12516. @end itemize
  12517. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  12518. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  12519. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  12520. filtergraph.
  12521. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  12522. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  12523. from that they act the same way.
  12524. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  12525. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  12526. @var{filename} option.
  12527. These filters accept the following options:
  12528. @table @option
  12529. @item commands, c
  12530. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  12531. @item filename, f
  12532. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  12533. filters.
  12534. @end table
  12535. @subsection Commands syntax
  12536. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  12537. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  12538. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  12539. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  12540. interval.
  12541. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  12542. @example
  12543. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  12544. @end example
  12545. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  12546. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  12547. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  12548. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  12549. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  12550. @var{END}.
  12551. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  12552. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  12553. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  12554. @example
  12555. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  12556. @end example
  12557. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  12558. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  12559. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  12560. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  12561. The following flags are recognized:
  12562. @table @option
  12563. @item enter
  12564. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  12565. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  12566. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  12567. current is.
  12568. @item leave
  12569. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  12570. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  12571. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  12572. current is not.
  12573. @end table
  12574. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  12575. assumed.
  12576. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  12577. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  12578. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  12579. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  12580. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  12581. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  12582. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  12583. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  12584. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  12585. follows:
  12586. @example
  12587. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  12588. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  12589. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  12590. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  12591. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  12592. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  12593. @end example
  12594. @subsection Examples
  12595. @itemize
  12596. @item
  12597. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  12598. @example
  12599. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  12600. @end example
  12601. @item
  12602. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  12603. @example
  12604. # show text in the interval 5-10
  12605. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  12606. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  12607. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  12608. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  12609. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  12610. [leave] hue s 1,
  12611. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  12612. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  12613. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  12614. @end example
  12615. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  12616. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  12617. @example
  12618. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  12619. @end example
  12620. @end itemize
  12621. @anchor{setpts}
  12622. @section setpts, asetpts
  12623. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  12624. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  12625. This filter accepts the following options:
  12626. @table @option
  12627. @item expr
  12628. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  12629. @end table
  12630. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  12631. constants:
  12632. @table @option
  12633. @item FRAME_RATE
  12634. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  12635. @item PTS
  12636. The presentation timestamp in input
  12637. @item N
  12638. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  12639. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  12640. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  12641. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  12642. audio)
  12643. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  12644. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  12645. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  12646. The audio sample rate.
  12647. @item STARTPTS
  12648. The PTS of the first frame.
  12649. @item STARTT
  12650. the time in seconds of the first frame
  12651. @item INTERLACED
  12652. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  12653. @item T
  12654. the time in seconds of the current frame
  12655. @item POS
  12656. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  12657. for the current frame
  12658. @item PREV_INPTS
  12659. The previous input PTS.
  12660. @item PREV_INT
  12661. previous input time in seconds
  12662. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  12663. The previous output PTS.
  12664. @item PREV_OUTT
  12665. previous output time in seconds
  12666. @item RTCTIME
  12667. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  12668. instead.
  12669. @item RTCSTART
  12670. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  12671. @item TB
  12672. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  12673. @end table
  12674. @subsection Examples
  12675. @itemize
  12676. @item
  12677. Start counting PTS from zero
  12678. @example
  12679. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  12680. @end example
  12681. @item
  12682. Apply fast motion effect:
  12683. @example
  12684. setpts=0.5*PTS
  12685. @end example
  12686. @item
  12687. Apply slow motion effect:
  12688. @example
  12689. setpts=2.0*PTS
  12690. @end example
  12691. @item
  12692. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  12693. @example
  12694. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  12695. @end example
  12696. @item
  12697. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  12698. @example
  12699. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  12700. @end example
  12701. @item
  12702. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  12703. @example
  12704. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  12705. @end example
  12706. @item
  12707. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  12708. @example
  12709. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  12710. @end example
  12711. @item
  12712. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  12713. @example
  12714. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  12715. @end example
  12716. @end itemize
  12717. @section settb, asettb
  12718. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  12719. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  12720. It accepts the following parameters:
  12721. @table @option
  12722. @item expr, tb
  12723. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  12724. @end table
  12725. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  12726. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  12727. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  12728. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  12729. @subsection Examples
  12730. @itemize
  12731. @item
  12732. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  12733. @example
  12734. settb=expr=1/25
  12735. @end example
  12736. @item
  12737. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  12738. @example
  12739. settb=expr=0.1
  12740. @end example
  12741. @item
  12742. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  12743. @example
  12744. settb=1+0.001
  12745. @end example
  12746. @item
  12747. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  12748. @example
  12749. settb=2*intb
  12750. @end example
  12751. @item
  12752. Set the default timebase value:
  12753. @example
  12754. settb=AVTB
  12755. @end example
  12756. @end itemize
  12757. @section showcqt
  12758. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  12759. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  12760. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  12761. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  12762. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  12763. The filter accepts the following options:
  12764. @table @option
  12765. @item size, s
  12766. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  12767. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12768. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  12769. @item fps, rate, r
  12770. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  12771. @item bar_h
  12772. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  12773. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  12774. @item axis_h
  12775. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  12776. the axis height automatically.
  12777. @item sono_h
  12778. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  12779. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  12780. @item fullhd
  12781. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  12782. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  12783. @item sono_v, volume
  12784. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  12785. @table @option
  12786. @item bar_v
  12787. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  12788. @item frequency, freq, f
  12789. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12790. @item timeclamp, tc
  12791. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12792. @end table
  12793. and functions:
  12794. @table @option
  12795. @item a_weighting(f)
  12796. A-weighting of equal loudness
  12797. @item b_weighting(f)
  12798. B-weighting of equal loudness
  12799. @item c_weighting(f)
  12800. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  12801. @end table
  12802. Default value is @code{16}.
  12803. @item bar_v, volume2
  12804. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  12805. @table @option
  12806. @item sono_v
  12807. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  12808. @item frequency, freq, f
  12809. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12810. @item timeclamp, tc
  12811. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12812. @end table
  12813. and functions:
  12814. @table @option
  12815. @item a_weighting(f)
  12816. A-weighting of equal loudness
  12817. @item b_weighting(f)
  12818. B-weighting of equal loudness
  12819. @item c_weighting(f)
  12820. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  12821. @end table
  12822. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  12823. @item sono_g, gamma
  12824. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  12825. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  12826. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  12827. @item bar_g, gamma2
  12828. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  12829. @code{[1, 7]}.
  12830. @item timeclamp, tc
  12831. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  12832. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  12833. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  12834. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  12835. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.1, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  12836. @item basefreq
  12837. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  12838. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  12839. @item endfreq
  12840. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  12841. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  12842. @item coeffclamp
  12843. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  12844. @item tlength
  12845. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  12846. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  12847. It can contain variables:
  12848. @table @option
  12849. @item frequency, freq, f
  12850. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12851. @item timeclamp, tc
  12852. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  12853. @end table
  12854. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  12855. @item count
  12856. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  12857. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  12858. @item fcount
  12859. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  12860. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  12861. @item fontfile
  12862. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  12863. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  12864. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  12865. option instead.
  12866. @item fontcolor
  12867. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  12868. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  12869. @table @option
  12870. @item frequency, freq, f
  12871. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12872. @item timeclamp, tc
  12873. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12874. @end table
  12875. and functions:
  12876. @table @option
  12877. @item midi(f)
  12878. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  12879. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  12880. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  12881. @end table
  12882. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  12883. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  12884. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  12885. @item axisfile
  12886. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  12887. @var{fontcolor} option.
  12888. @item axis, text
  12889. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  12890. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  12891. Default value is @code{1}.
  12892. @end table
  12893. @subsection Examples
  12894. @itemize
  12895. @item
  12896. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  12897. @example
  12898. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  12899. @end example
  12900. @item
  12901. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  12902. @example
  12903. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  12904. @end example
  12905. @item
  12906. Playing at 1280x720:
  12907. @example
  12908. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  12909. @end example
  12910. @item
  12911. Disable sonogram display:
  12912. @example
  12913. sono_h=0
  12914. @end example
  12915. @item
  12916. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  12917. @example
  12918. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  12919. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  12920. @end example
  12921. @item
  12922. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  12923. @example
  12924. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  12925. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  12926. @end example
  12927. @item
  12928. Custom volume:
  12929. @example
  12930. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  12931. @end example
  12932. @item
  12933. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  12934. @example
  12935. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  12936. @end example
  12937. @item
  12938. Custom tlength equation:
  12939. @example
  12940. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  12941. @end example
  12942. @item
  12943. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  12944. @example
  12945. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  12946. @end example
  12947. @item
  12948. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  12949. @example
  12950. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  12951. @end example
  12952. @end itemize
  12953. @section showfreqs
  12954. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  12955. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  12956. The filter accepts the following options:
  12957. @table @option
  12958. @item size, s
  12959. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12960. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12961. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  12962. @item mode
  12963. Set display mode.
  12964. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  12965. It accepts the following values:
  12966. @table @samp
  12967. @item line
  12968. @item bar
  12969. @item dot
  12970. @end table
  12971. Default is @code{bar}.
  12972. @item ascale
  12973. Set amplitude scale.
  12974. It accepts the following values:
  12975. @table @samp
  12976. @item lin
  12977. Linear scale.
  12978. @item sqrt
  12979. Square root scale.
  12980. @item cbrt
  12981. Cubic root scale.
  12982. @item log
  12983. Logarithmic scale.
  12984. @end table
  12985. Default is @code{log}.
  12986. @item fscale
  12987. Set frequency scale.
  12988. It accepts the following values:
  12989. @table @samp
  12990. @item lin
  12991. Linear scale.
  12992. @item log
  12993. Logarithmic scale.
  12994. @item rlog
  12995. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  12996. @end table
  12997. Default is @code{lin}.
  12998. @item win_size
  12999. Set window size.
  13000. It accepts the following values:
  13001. @table @samp
  13002. @item w16
  13003. @item w32
  13004. @item w64
  13005. @item w128
  13006. @item w256
  13007. @item w512
  13008. @item w1024
  13009. @item w2048
  13010. @item w4096
  13011. @item w8192
  13012. @item w16384
  13013. @item w32768
  13014. @item w65536
  13015. @end table
  13016. Default is @code{w2048}
  13017. @item win_func
  13018. Set windowing function.
  13019. It accepts the following values:
  13020. @table @samp
  13021. @item rect
  13022. @item bartlett
  13023. @item hanning
  13024. @item hamming
  13025. @item blackman
  13026. @item welch
  13027. @item flattop
  13028. @item bharris
  13029. @item bnuttall
  13030. @item bhann
  13031. @item sine
  13032. @item nuttall
  13033. @item lanczos
  13034. @item gauss
  13035. @item tukey
  13036. @item dolph
  13037. @item cauchy
  13038. @item parzen
  13039. @item poisson
  13040. @end table
  13041. Default is @code{hanning}.
  13042. @item overlap
  13043. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  13044. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  13045. @item averaging
  13046. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  13047. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  13048. @item colors
  13049. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  13050. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  13051. by white color.
  13052. @item cmode
  13053. Set channel display mode.
  13054. It accepts the following values:
  13055. @table @samp
  13056. @item combined
  13057. @item separate
  13058. @end table
  13059. Default is @code{combined}.
  13060. @item minamp
  13061. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  13062. @end table
  13063. @anchor{showspectrum}
  13064. @section showspectrum
  13065. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  13066. spectrum.
  13067. The filter accepts the following options:
  13068. @table @option
  13069. @item size, s
  13070. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13071. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13072. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  13073. @item slide
  13074. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  13075. It accepts the following values:
  13076. @table @samp
  13077. @item replace
  13078. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  13079. @item scroll
  13080. the samples scroll from right to left
  13081. @item fullframe
  13082. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  13083. @item rscroll
  13084. the samples scroll from left to right
  13085. @end table
  13086. Default value is @code{replace}.
  13087. @item mode
  13088. Specify display mode.
  13089. It accepts the following values:
  13090. @table @samp
  13091. @item combined
  13092. all channels are displayed in the same row
  13093. @item separate
  13094. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  13095. @end table
  13096. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  13097. @item color
  13098. Specify display color mode.
  13099. It accepts the following values:
  13100. @table @samp
  13101. @item channel
  13102. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  13103. @item intensity
  13104. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  13105. @item rainbow
  13106. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  13107. @item moreland
  13108. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  13109. @item nebulae
  13110. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  13111. @item fire
  13112. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  13113. @item fiery
  13114. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  13115. @item fruit
  13116. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  13117. @item cool
  13118. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  13119. @end table
  13120. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  13121. @item scale
  13122. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  13123. It accepts the following values:
  13124. @table @samp
  13125. @item lin
  13126. linear
  13127. @item sqrt
  13128. square root, default
  13129. @item cbrt
  13130. cubic root
  13131. @item log
  13132. logarithmic
  13133. @item 4thrt
  13134. 4th root
  13135. @item 5thrt
  13136. 5th root
  13137. @end table
  13138. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  13139. @item saturation
  13140. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  13141. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  13142. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  13143. Default value is @code{1}.
  13144. @item win_func
  13145. Set window function.
  13146. It accepts the following values:
  13147. @table @samp
  13148. @item rect
  13149. @item bartlett
  13150. @item hann
  13151. @item hanning
  13152. @item hamming
  13153. @item blackman
  13154. @item welch
  13155. @item flattop
  13156. @item bharris
  13157. @item bnuttall
  13158. @item bhann
  13159. @item sine
  13160. @item nuttall
  13161. @item lanczos
  13162. @item gauss
  13163. @item tukey
  13164. @item dolph
  13165. @item cauchy
  13166. @item parzen
  13167. @item poisson
  13168. @end table
  13169. Default value is @code{hann}.
  13170. @item orientation
  13171. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  13172. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13173. @item overlap
  13174. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  13175. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  13176. window function currently used.
  13177. @item gain
  13178. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  13179. Default value is @code{1}.
  13180. @item data
  13181. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  13182. @item rotation
  13183. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  13184. Default value is @code{0}.
  13185. @end table
  13186. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  13187. section.
  13188. @subsection Examples
  13189. @itemize
  13190. @item
  13191. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  13192. @example
  13193. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  13194. @end example
  13195. @item
  13196. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  13197. @example
  13198. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  13199. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  13200. @end example
  13201. @end itemize
  13202. @section showspectrumpic
  13203. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  13204. spectrum.
  13205. The filter accepts the following options:
  13206. @table @option
  13207. @item size, s
  13208. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13209. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13210. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  13211. @item mode
  13212. Specify display mode.
  13213. It accepts the following values:
  13214. @table @samp
  13215. @item combined
  13216. all channels are displayed in the same row
  13217. @item separate
  13218. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  13219. @end table
  13220. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  13221. @item color
  13222. Specify display color mode.
  13223. It accepts the following values:
  13224. @table @samp
  13225. @item channel
  13226. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  13227. @item intensity
  13228. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  13229. @item rainbow
  13230. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  13231. @item moreland
  13232. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  13233. @item nebulae
  13234. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  13235. @item fire
  13236. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  13237. @item fiery
  13238. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  13239. @item fruit
  13240. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  13241. @item cool
  13242. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  13243. @end table
  13244. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  13245. @item scale
  13246. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  13247. It accepts the following values:
  13248. @table @samp
  13249. @item lin
  13250. linear
  13251. @item sqrt
  13252. square root, default
  13253. @item cbrt
  13254. cubic root
  13255. @item log
  13256. logarithmic
  13257. @item 4thrt
  13258. 4th root
  13259. @item 5thrt
  13260. 5th root
  13261. @end table
  13262. Default value is @samp{log}.
  13263. @item saturation
  13264. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  13265. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  13266. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  13267. Default value is @code{1}.
  13268. @item win_func
  13269. Set window function.
  13270. It accepts the following values:
  13271. @table @samp
  13272. @item rect
  13273. @item bartlett
  13274. @item hann
  13275. @item hanning
  13276. @item hamming
  13277. @item blackman
  13278. @item welch
  13279. @item flattop
  13280. @item bharris
  13281. @item bnuttall
  13282. @item bhann
  13283. @item sine
  13284. @item nuttall
  13285. @item lanczos
  13286. @item gauss
  13287. @item tukey
  13288. @item dolph
  13289. @item cauchy
  13290. @item parzen
  13291. @item poisson
  13292. @end table
  13293. Default value is @code{hann}.
  13294. @item orientation
  13295. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  13296. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13297. @item gain
  13298. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  13299. Default value is @code{1}.
  13300. @item legend
  13301. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  13302. @item rotation
  13303. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  13304. Default value is @code{0}.
  13305. @end table
  13306. @subsection Examples
  13307. @itemize
  13308. @item
  13309. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  13310. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  13311. @example
  13312. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  13313. @end example
  13314. @end itemize
  13315. @section showvolume
  13316. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  13317. The filter accepts the following options:
  13318. @table @option
  13319. @item rate, r
  13320. Set video rate.
  13321. @item b
  13322. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  13323. @item w
  13324. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  13325. @item h
  13326. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  13327. @item f
  13328. Set fade, allowed range is [0.001, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  13329. @item c
  13330. Set volume color expression.
  13331. The expression can use the following variables:
  13332. @table @option
  13333. @item VOLUME
  13334. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  13335. @item PEAK
  13336. Current peak.
  13337. @item CHANNEL
  13338. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  13339. @end table
  13340. @item t
  13341. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  13342. @item v
  13343. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  13344. @item o
  13345. Set orientation, can be @code{horizontal} or @code{vertical},
  13346. default is @code{horizontal}.
  13347. @item s
  13348. Set step size, allowed range s [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  13349. step is disabled.
  13350. @end table
  13351. @section showwaves
  13352. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  13353. The filter accepts the following options:
  13354. @table @option
  13355. @item size, s
  13356. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13357. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13358. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  13359. @item mode
  13360. Set display mode.
  13361. Available values are:
  13362. @table @samp
  13363. @item point
  13364. Draw a point for each sample.
  13365. @item line
  13366. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  13367. @item p2p
  13368. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  13369. @item cline
  13370. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  13371. @end table
  13372. Default value is @code{point}.
  13373. @item n
  13374. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  13375. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  13376. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  13377. is not explicitly specified.
  13378. @item rate, r
  13379. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  13380. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  13381. @item split_channels
  13382. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  13383. @item colors
  13384. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  13385. @item scale
  13386. Set amplitude scale.
  13387. Available values are:
  13388. @table @samp
  13389. @item lin
  13390. Linear.
  13391. @item log
  13392. Logarithmic.
  13393. @item sqrt
  13394. Square root.
  13395. @item cbrt
  13396. Cubic root.
  13397. @end table
  13398. Default is linear.
  13399. @end table
  13400. @subsection Examples
  13401. @itemize
  13402. @item
  13403. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  13404. at the same time:
  13405. @example
  13406. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  13407. @end example
  13408. @item
  13409. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  13410. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  13411. @example
  13412. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  13413. @end example
  13414. @end itemize
  13415. @section showwavespic
  13416. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  13417. The filter accepts the following options:
  13418. @table @option
  13419. @item size, s
  13420. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13421. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13422. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  13423. @item split_channels
  13424. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  13425. @item colors
  13426. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  13427. @item scale
  13428. Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
  13429. Default is linear.
  13430. @end table
  13431. @subsection Examples
  13432. @itemize
  13433. @item
  13434. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  13435. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  13436. @example
  13437. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  13438. @end example
  13439. @end itemize
  13440. @section spectrumsynth
  13441. Sythesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  13442. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  13443. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  13444. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  13445. This filter is primarly created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  13446. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  13447. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  13448. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  13449. its just recreated from random noise.
  13450. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  13451. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  13452. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  13453. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  13454. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  13455. The filter accepts the following options:
  13456. @table @option
  13457. @item sample_rate
  13458. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  13459. spectrum was generated may differ.
  13460. @item channels
  13461. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  13462. @item scale
  13463. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  13464. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  13465. @item slide
  13466. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  13467. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  13468. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  13469. @item win_func
  13470. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  13471. @item overlap
  13472. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  13473. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  13474. @item orientation
  13475. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  13476. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13477. @end table
  13478. @subsection Examples
  13479. @itemize
  13480. @item
  13481. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  13482. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  13483. @example
  13484. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  13485. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  13486. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  13487. @end example
  13488. @end itemize
  13489. @section split, asplit
  13490. Split input into several identical outputs.
  13491. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  13492. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  13493. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  13494. @subsection Examples
  13495. @itemize
  13496. @item
  13497. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  13498. @example
  13499. [in] split [out0][out1]
  13500. @end example
  13501. @item
  13502. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  13503. outputs, like in:
  13504. @example
  13505. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  13506. @end example
  13507. @item
  13508. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  13509. one padded:
  13510. @example
  13511. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  13512. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  13513. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  13514. @end example
  13515. @item
  13516. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13517. @example
  13518. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  13519. @end example
  13520. @end itemize
  13521. @section zmq, azmq
  13522. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  13523. filters in the filtergraph.
  13524. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  13525. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  13526. audio filters.
  13527. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  13528. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  13529. For more information about libzmq see:
  13530. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  13531. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  13532. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  13533. @option{bind_address} option.
  13534. The received message must be in the form:
  13535. @example
  13536. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  13537. @end example
  13538. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  13539. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  13540. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  13541. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  13542. given @var{COMMAND}.
  13543. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  13544. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  13545. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  13546. @example
  13547. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  13548. @var{MESSAGE}
  13549. @end example
  13550. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  13551. @subsection Examples
  13552. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  13553. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  13554. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}
  13555. @example
  13556. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  13557. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  13558. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  13559. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  13560. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  13561. [bg+l][r] overlay=x=100 "
  13562. @end example
  13563. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  13564. command can be used:
  13565. @example
  13566. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  13567. @end example
  13568. To change the right side:
  13569. @example
  13570. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  13571. @end example
  13572. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  13573. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  13574. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  13575. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  13576. @section amovie
  13577. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  13578. stream by default.
  13579. @anchor{movie}
  13580. @section movie
  13581. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  13582. It accepts the following parameters:
  13583. @table @option
  13584. @item filename
  13585. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  13586. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  13587. @item format_name, f
  13588. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  13589. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  13590. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  13591. @item seek_point, sp
  13592. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  13593. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  13594. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  13595. postfix. The default value is "0".
  13596. @item streams, s
  13597. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  13598. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  13599. same order. The syntax is explained in the ``Stream specifiers''
  13600. section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  13601. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  13602. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  13603. @item stream_index, si
  13604. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  13605. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  13606. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  13607. audio instead of video.
  13608. @item loop
  13609. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  13610. If the value is less than 1, the stream will be read again and again.
  13611. Default value is "1".
  13612. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  13613. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  13614. @item discontinuity
  13615. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  13616. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  13617. timestamps.
  13618. @end table
  13619. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  13620. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  13621. @example
  13622. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  13623. ^
  13624. |
  13625. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  13626. @end example
  13627. @subsection Examples
  13628. @itemize
  13629. @item
  13630. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  13631. on top of the input labelled "in":
  13632. @example
  13633. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  13634. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13635. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  13636. @end example
  13637. @item
  13638. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  13639. labelled "in":
  13640. @example
  13641. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  13642. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13643. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  13644. @end example
  13645. @item
  13646. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  13647. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  13648. connected to the pad named "audio":
  13649. @example
  13650. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  13651. @end example
  13652. @end itemize
  13653. @subsection Commands
  13654. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  13655. @table @option
  13656. @item seek
  13657. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  13658. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  13659. @itemize
  13660. @item
  13661. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  13662. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  13663. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  13664. @item
  13665. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  13666. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  13667. @item
  13668. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  13669. @end itemize
  13670. @item get_duration
  13671. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  13672. @end table
  13673. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES